diff options
author | ralph <ralph@3c298f89-4303-0410-b956-a3cf2f4a3e73> | 2010-03-30 13:51:10 +0000 |
---|---|---|
committer | ralph <ralph@3c298f89-4303-0410-b956-a3cf2f4a3e73> | 2010-03-30 13:51:10 +0000 |
commit | e0e232b87230222418b8df5444e2975e1a6ceb33 (patch) | |
tree | e4727c782838f4918bc948c796237d9669fac1f3 /package/uboot-lantiq | |
parent | ed42a8a32363683414d3aeba3bbbd242831b6adb (diff) |
missing patch & config file
git-svn-id: svn://svn.openwrt.org/openwrt/trunk@20604 3c298f89-4303-0410-b956-a3cf2f4a3e73
Diffstat (limited to 'package/uboot-lantiq')
-rw-r--r-- | package/uboot-lantiq/Config.in | 32 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | package/uboot-lantiq/patches/300-httpd.patch | 9349 |
2 files changed, 9381 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/package/uboot-lantiq/Config.in b/package/uboot-lantiq/Config.in new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7544e711df --- /dev/null +++ b/package/uboot-lantiq/Config.in @@ -0,0 +1,32 @@ +config UBOOT_CONFIG + string "configuration file" + default "easy50712_DDR166M" + help + The configuration reflects the settings for a dedicated board hardware. + Select for Danube evaluation board easy50712_DDR166M . + Select for AR9 evaluation board easy50812_DDR166M . + +config UBOOT_DDR_CONFIG + string "DDR configuration file" + default "danube_ref_ddr166.conf" + depends on UBOOT_RAMBOOT + help + The DDR configuration file should reflect the DDR memory device configuration . + It will be used to create a RAM boot image + Select for Danube evalution board danube_ref_ddr166.conf . + Select for AR9 evalution board easy50812.conf . + +config UBOOT_RAMBOOT + bool "Enable RAM boot image" + help + Using the UART boot mode of the ROM code this image could be loaded to the RAM. + Executing the image in the RAM the functionality of the uboot image can be + tested first without touching the original flash. + Note: Be carefull, by saving the environment the flash will be modified. + The OWRT flash layout differs from the layout provided by Lantiq / Infineon. + +config IFXMIPS_UBOOT_A800 + bool "add ARV452 Switch bringup hack" + depends on PACKAGE_uboot-ifxmips + help + Say Y, if you have a arv452 board (wav-281, A800, ..) diff --git a/package/uboot-lantiq/patches/300-httpd.patch b/package/uboot-lantiq/patches/300-httpd.patch new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f9a81e90c6 --- /dev/null +++ b/package/uboot-lantiq/patches/300-httpd.patch @@ -0,0 +1,9349 @@ +--- a/common/cmd_net.c ++++ b/common/cmd_net.c +@@ -43,6 +43,18 @@ U_BOOT_CMD( + "[loadAddress] [[hostIPaddr:]bootfilename]" + ); + ++#if defined(CONFIG_CMD_HTTPD) ++int do_httpd (cmd_tbl_t *cmdtp, int flag, int argc, char *argv[]) ++{ ++ return NetLoopHttpd(); ++} ++ ++U_BOOT_CMD( ++ httpd, 1, 1, do_httpd, ++ "httpd\t- start webserver\n", "\n" ++); ++#endif ++ + int do_tftpb (cmd_tbl_t *cmdtp, int flag, int argc, char *argv[]) + { + return netboot_common (TFTP, cmdtp, argc, argv); +--- a/include/net.h ++++ b/include/net.h +@@ -383,7 +383,8 @@ extern int NetTimeOffset; /* offset ti + + /* Initialize the network adapter */ + extern int NetLoop(proto_t); +- ++extern int NetLoopHttpd(void); ++extern void NetSendHttpd(void); + /* Shutdown adapters and cleanup */ + extern void NetStop(void); + +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/httpd.c +@@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ ++/* ++ * Copyright 1994, 1995, 2000 Neil Russell. ++ * (See License) ++ * Copyright 2000, 2001 DENX Software Engineering, Wolfgang Denk, wd@denx.de ++ */ ++ ++#include <common.h> ++#include <command.h> ++#include <net.h> ++#include "uip-0.9/uipopt.h" ++#include "uip-0.9/uip.h" ++#include "uip-0.9/uip_arp.h" ++ ++ ++#if defined(CONFIG_CMD_HTTPD) ++ ++#define TIMEOUT 5 ++ ++static int arptimer = 0; ++ ++void ++HttpdHandler (void) ++{ ++ int i; ++ for(i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; i++) { ++ uip_periodic(i); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ uip_arp_out(); ++ NetSendHttpd(); ++ } ++ } ++ if(++arptimer == 20) { ++ uip_arp_timer(); ++ arptimer = 0; ++ } ++} ++ ++static void ++HttpdTimeout (void) ++{ ++ puts ("T "); ++ NetSetTimeout (TIMEOUT * 1000, HttpdTimeout); ++} ++ ++void ++HttpdStart (void) ++{ ++ uip_init(); ++ httpd_init(); ++} ++ ++#endif +--- /dev/null ++++ b/include/httpd.h +@@ -0,0 +1,17 @@ ++#ifndef _UIP_HTTPD_H__ ++#define _UIP_HTTPD_H__ ++ ++void HttpdStart (void); ++void HttpdHandler (void); ++ ++/* board specific implementation */ ++extern int do_http_upgrade(const unsigned char *data, const ulong size); ++ ++#define HTTP_PROGRESS_START 0 ++#define HTTP_PROGRESS_TIMEOUT 1 ++#define HTTP_PROGRESS_UPLOAD_READY 2 ++#define HTTP_PROGRESS_UGRADE_READY 3 ++#define HTTP_PROGRESS_UGRADE_FAILED 4 ++extern int do_http_progress(const int state); ++ ++#endif +--- a/net/Makefile ++++ b/net/Makefile +@@ -26,6 +26,10 @@ include $(TOPDIR)/config.mk + # CFLAGS += -DDEBUG + + LIB = $(obj)libnet.a ++UIPDIR = uip-0.9 ++RSADIR = uip-0.9 ++$(shell mkdir -p $(obj)$(UIPDIR)) ++$(shell mkdir -p $(obj)$(RSADIR)) + + COBJS-y += bootp.o + COBJS-$(CONFIG_CMD_DNS) += dns.o +@@ -36,6 +40,9 @@ COBJS-y += rarp.o + COBJS-$(CONFIG_CMD_SNTP) += sntp.o + COBJS-y += tftp.o + ++COBJS-$(CONFIG_CMD_HTTPD) += httpd.o $(UIPDIR)/fs.o $(UIPDIR)/httpd.o $(UIPDIR)/uip_arp.o $(UIPDIR)/uip_arch.o $(UIPDIR)/uip.o ++COBJS-$(CONFIG_CMD_RSA) += $(RSADIR)/bigint.o $(RSADIR)/base64.o $(RSADIR)/rmd160.o $(RSADIR)/rsa.o ++ + COBJS := $(COBJS-y) + SRCS := $(COBJS:.o=.c) + OBJS := $(addprefix $(obj),$(COBJS)) +--- a/net/net.c ++++ b/net/net.c +@@ -95,6 +95,19 @@ + #if defined(CONFIG_CMD_DNS) + #include "dns.h" + #endif ++#if defined(CONFIG_CMD_HTTPD) ++#include "httpd.h" ++#include "uip-0.9/uipopt.h" ++#include "uip-0.9/uip.h" ++#include "uip-0.9/uip_arp.h" ++static int https_running = 0; ++int httpd_upload_complete = 0; ++unsigned char *httpd_upload_data = 0; ++extern int upload_running; ++void NetReceiveHttpd(volatile uchar * inpkt, int len); ++void NetSendHttpd(void); ++extern int do_reset (cmd_tbl_t *cmdtp, int flag, int argc, char *argv[]); ++#endif + + #if defined(CONFIG_CMD_NET) + +@@ -1310,6 +1323,13 @@ NetReceive(volatile uchar * inpkt, int l + + debug("packet received\n"); + ++#if defined(CONFIG_CMD_HTTPD) ++ if(https_running) { ++ NetReceiveHttpd(inpkt, len); ++ return; ++ } ++#endif ++ + NetRxPacket = inpkt; + NetRxPacketLen = len; + et = (Ethernet_t *)inpkt; +@@ -1952,3 +1972,161 @@ ushort getenv_VLAN(char *var) + { + return (string_to_VLAN(getenv(var))); + } ++ ++#if defined(CONFIG_CMD_HTTPD) ++ ++void ++NetSendHttpd(void) ++{ ++ volatile uchar *tmpbuf = NetTxPacket; ++ int i; ++ ++ for(i = 0; i < 40 + UIP_LLH_LEN; i++) { ++ tmpbuf[i] = uip_buf[i]; ++ } ++ ++ for(; i < uip_len; i++) { ++ tmpbuf[i] = uip_appdata[i - 40 - UIP_LLH_LEN]; ++ } ++ eth_send(NetTxPacket, uip_len); ++} ++ ++#define BUF ((struct uip_eth_hdr *)&uip_buf[0]) ++ ++void ++NetReceiveHttpd(volatile uchar * inpkt, int len) ++{ ++ memcpy(uip_buf, inpkt, len); ++ uip_len = len; ++ if(BUF->type == htons(UIP_ETHTYPE_IP)) { ++ uip_arp_ipin(); ++ uip_input(); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ uip_arp_out(); ++ NetSendHttpd(); ++ } ++ } else if(BUF->type == htons(UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP)) { ++ uip_arp_arpin(); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ NetSendHttpd(); ++ } ++ } ++} ++ ++int ++NetLoopHttpd(void) ++{ ++ unsigned long long tout = 0; ++ bd_t *bd = gd->bd; ++ unsigned short int ip[2]; ++ ++#ifdef CONFIG_NET_MULTI ++ NetRestarted = 0; ++ NetDevExists = 0; ++#endif ++ ++ /* XXX problem with bss workaround */ ++ NetArpWaitPacketMAC = NULL; ++ NetArpWaitTxPacket = NULL; ++ NetArpWaitPacketIP = 0; ++ NetArpWaitReplyIP = 0; ++ NetArpWaitTxPacket = NULL; ++ NetTxPacket = NULL; ++ NetTryCount = 1; ++ ++ if (!NetTxPacket) { ++ int i; ++ /* ++ * Setup packet buffers, aligned correctly. ++ */ ++ NetTxPacket = &PktBuf[0] + (PKTALIGN - 1); ++ NetTxPacket -= (ulong)NetTxPacket % PKTALIGN; ++ for (i = 0; i < PKTBUFSRX; i++) { ++ NetRxPackets[i] = NetTxPacket + (i+1)*PKTSIZE_ALIGN; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ if (!NetArpWaitTxPacket) { ++ NetArpWaitTxPacket = &NetArpWaitPacketBuf[0] + (PKTALIGN - 1); ++ NetArpWaitTxPacket -= (ulong)NetArpWaitTxPacket % PKTALIGN; ++ NetArpWaitTxPacketSize = 0; ++ } ++ ++ eth_halt(); ++#ifdef CONFIG_NET_MULTI ++ eth_set_current(); ++#endif ++ if (eth_init(bd) < 0) { ++ eth_halt(); ++ return(-1); ++ } ++ ++restart: ++#ifdef CONFIG_NET_MULTI ++ memcpy (NetOurEther, eth_get_dev()->enetaddr, 6); ++#else ++ eth_getenv_enetaddr("ethaddr", NetOurEther); ++#endif ++ ++ NetCopyIP(&NetOurIP, &bd->bi_ip_addr); ++ NetOurGatewayIP = getenv_IPaddr ("gatewayip"); ++ NetOurSubnetMask= getenv_IPaddr ("netmask"); ++ NetOurVLAN = getenv_VLAN("vlan"); ++ NetOurNativeVLAN = getenv_VLAN("nvlan"); ++ ++ printf("starting httpd server from server %ld.%ld.%ld.%ld\n", ++ (bd->bi_ip_addr & 0xff000000) >> 24, ++ (bd->bi_ip_addr & 0x00ff0000) >> 16, ++ (bd->bi_ip_addr & 0x0000ff00) >> 8, ++ (bd->bi_ip_addr & 0x000000ff)); ++ ++ HttpdStart(); ++ ++ ip[0] = ((bd->bi_ip_addr & 0xffff0000) >> 16); ++ ip[1] = (bd->bi_ip_addr & 0x0000ffff); ++ uip_sethostaddr(ip); ++ ++ do_http_progress(HTTP_PROGRESS_START); ++ ++ https_running = 1; ++ for (;;) { ++ unsigned long long t1; ++ WATCHDOG_RESET(); ++ if(eth_rx() > 0) { ++ HttpdHandler(); ++ } else { ++ t1 = get_ticks(); ++ if(t1 - tout > 1000) { ++ do_http_progress(HTTP_PROGRESS_TIMEOUT); ++ tout = t1; ++ } ++ } ++ if(!httpd_upload_complete) ++ continue; ++ printf("Bytes transferred = %ld (%lx hex)\n", ++ NetBootFileXferSize, ++ NetBootFileXferSize); ++ eth_halt(); ++ do_http_progress(HTTP_PROGRESS_UPLOAD_READY); ++ if(do_http_upgrade(&httpd_upload_data[0], NetBootFileXferSize) == 0) { ++ do_http_progress(HTTP_PROGRESS_UGRADE_READY); ++ udelay(1000 * 10); ++ do_reset (0,0,0,0); ++ return 0; ++ } ++ break; ++ } ++ https_running = 0; ++ NetBootFileXferSize = 0; ++ httpd_upload_complete = 0; ++ upload_running = 0; ++// free(httpd_upload_data); ++ ++ do_http_progress(HTTP_PROGRESS_UGRADE_FAILED); ++ ++ goto restart; ++ ++ return -1; ++} ++ ++#endif +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/base64.c +@@ -0,0 +1,137 @@ ++#include "base64.h" ++ ++static const char cb64[]="ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZabcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz0123456789+/"; ++/* Note that '=' (padding) is 0 */ ++static const unsigned char fb64[256] = { ++ 255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255, ++ 255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255, ++ 255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255, 62,255,255,255, 63, ++ 52, 53, 54, 55, 56, 57, 58, 59, 60, 61,255,255,255, 0,255,255, ++ 255, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, ++ 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25,255,255,255,255,255, ++ 255, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, ++ 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, 50, 51,255,255,255,255,255, ++ 255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255, ++ 255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255, ++ 255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255, ++ 255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255, ++ 255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255, ++ 255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255, ++ 255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255, ++ 255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255,255, ++}; ++ ++static int encodeblock( unsigned char *in, char *out, int len ) ++{ ++ char s[3]; ++ int i; ++ ++ for (i = 0; i < len; i++) ++ s[i] = in[i]; ++ for (i = len; i < 3; i++) ++ s[i] = 0; ++ out[0] = (unsigned char)(cb64[(s[0] & 0xfc) >> 2 ]); ++ out[1] = (unsigned char)(cb64[((s[0] & 0x03) << 4) | ((s[1] & 0xf0) >> 4) ]); ++ out[2] = (unsigned char)(cb64[((s[1] & 0x0f) << 2) | ((s[2] & 0xc0) >> 6) ]); ++ out[3] = (unsigned char)(cb64[s[2] & 0x3f ]); ++ switch (len) { ++ case 1: ++ out[3] = '='; ++ case 2: ++ out[2] = '='; ++ break; ++ default: ++ break; ++ } ++ ++ return 4; ++} ++ ++static int decodeblock(char *ins, unsigned char *out, int len) ++{ ++ int i; ++ unsigned char in[4]; ++ int skip = 0; ++ ++ if (len != 4) ++ return -1; ++ for (i = 0; i < len; i++) { ++ if (ins[i] == '=') { ++ in[i] = 0; ++ skip++; ++ } else ++ in[i] = fb64[(int)(ins[i])]; ++ if (in[i] == 255) { ++ return -1; ++ } ++ } ++ out[0] = (unsigned char ) (in[0] << 2 | in[1] >> 4); ++ if (skip == 2) { ++ return 1; ++ } ++ out[1] = (unsigned char )((in[1] & 0x0f) << 4 | in[2] >> 2); ++ if (skip == 1) { ++ return 2; ++ } ++ out[2] = (unsigned char ) (((in[2] << 6) & 0xc0) | in[3]); ++ ++ return 3; ++} ++ ++int B64_encode(char *source, char *destination, int size_source, int size_destination) ++{ ++ int chunks, reminder, size, d, i, size_expected; ++ char *s; ++ unsigned char *t; ++ ++ chunks = size_source / 3; ++ reminder = size_source % 3; ++ size = 0; ++ size_expected = (chunks * 4) + (reminder?(reminder + 1):0); ++ if (size_destination < ((chunks * 4) + (reminder?4:0))) { ++ return 1; ++ } ++ for (i = 0; i < chunks; i++) { ++ s = source + (i * 3); ++ t = destination + (i * 4); ++ d = encodeblock(s, t, 3); ++ if (d == -1) { ++ return 1; ++ } ++ size += d; ++ } ++ if (reminder) { ++ d = encodeblock(source + (chunks * 3), destination + (chunks * 4), reminder); ++ if (d == -1) { ++ return 1; ++ } ++ size += d; ++ } ++ return size; ++} ++ ++int B64_decode(char *source, char *destination, int size_source, int size_destination) ++{ ++ int chunks, reminder, size, d, i; ++ ++ chunks = size_source / 4; ++ reminder = size_source % 4; ++ size = 0; ++ if (reminder) { ++ return 1; ++ } ++ if (size_destination < ((chunks * 3))) { ++ printf("%d, %d\n", ++ size_destination, ((chunks * 3) + reminder)); ++ return -1; ++ } ++ for (i = 0; i < chunks; i++) { ++ d = decodeblock(source + (i * 4), destination + (i * 3), 4); ++ if (d == -1) { ++ return -1; ++ } ++ size += d; ++ } ++ return size; ++} ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/base64.h +@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@ ++#ifndef _BASE64_H_ ++#define _BASE64_H_ ++#ifdef __cplusplus ++extern "C" { ++#endif ++int B64_encode(char *source, char *destination, int size_source, int size_destination); ++int B64_decode(char *source, char *destination, int size_source, int size_destination); ++#ifdef __cplusplus ++} ++#endif ++#endif +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/bigint.c +@@ -0,0 +1,906 @@ ++/* ++ * Copyright(C) 2006 ++ * ++ * This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify ++ * it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by ++ * the Free Software Foundation; either version 2.1 of the License, or ++ * (at your option) any later version. ++ * ++ * This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, ++ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of ++ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the ++ * GNU Lesser General Public License for more details. ++ * ++ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License ++ * along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software ++ * Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * @defgroup bigint_api Big Integer API ++ * @brief The bigint implementation as used by the axTLS project. ++ * ++ * The bigint library is for RSA encryption/decryption as well as signing. ++ * This code tries to minimise use of malloc/free by maintaining a small ++ * cache. A bigint context may maintain state by being made "permanent". ++ * It be be later released with a bi_depermanent() and bi_free() call. ++ * ++ * It supports the following reduction techniques: ++ * - Classical ++ * - Barrett ++ * - Montgomery ++ * ++ * It also implements the following: ++ * - Karatsuba multiplication ++ * - Squaring ++ * - Sliding window exponentiation ++ * - Chinese Remainder Theorem (implemented in rsa.c). ++ * ++ * All the algorithms used are pretty standard, and designed for different ++ * data bus sizes. Negative numbers are not dealt with at all, so a subtraction ++ * may need to be tested for negativity. ++ * ++ * This library steals some ideas from Jef Poskanzer ++ * <http://cs.marlboro.edu/term/cs-fall02/algorithms/crypto/RSA/bigint> ++ * and GMP <http://www.swox.com/gmp>. It gets most of its implementation ++ * detail from "The Handbook of Applied Cryptography" ++ * <http://www.cacr.math.uwaterloo.ca/hac/about/chap14.pdf> ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++#include "bigint.h" ++#include <malloc.h> ++#include "div64.h" ++ ++static bigint *bi_int_multiply(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bi, comp i); ++static bigint *bi_int_divide(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *biR, comp denom); ++static bigint *alloc(BI_CTX *ctx, int size); ++static bigint *trim(bigint *bi); ++static void more_comps(bigint *bi, int n); ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Start a new bigint context. ++ * @return A bigint context. ++ */ ++BI_CTX *bi_initialize(void) ++{ ++ BI_CTX *ctx = (BI_CTX *)calloc(1, sizeof(BI_CTX)); ++ ++ ctx->active_list = NULL; ++ ctx->active_count = 0; ++ ctx->free_list = NULL; ++ ctx->free_count = 0; ++ ctx->mod_offset = 0; ++ ++ /* the radix */ ++ ctx->bi_radix = alloc(ctx, 2); ++ ctx->bi_radix->comps[0] = 0; ++ ctx->bi_radix->comps[1] = 1; ++ bi_permanent(ctx->bi_radix); ++ ++ return ctx; ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Close the bigint context and free any resources. ++ * ++ * Free up any used memory - a check is done if all objects were not ++ * properly freed. ++ * @param ctx [in] The bigint session context. ++ */ ++void bi_terminate(BI_CTX *ctx) ++{ ++ bigint *p, *pn; ++ ++ bi_depermanent(ctx->bi_radix); ++ bi_free(ctx, ctx->bi_radix); ++ ++ if (ctx->active_count != 0) ++ { ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ return; ++ } ++ ++ for (p = ctx->free_list; p != NULL; p = pn) ++ { ++ pn = p->next; ++ free(p->comps); ++ free(p); ++ } ++ ++ free(ctx); ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Increment the number of references to this object. ++ * It does not do a full copy. ++ * @param bi [in] The bigint to copy. ++ * @return A referent to the same bigint. ++ */ ++bigint *bi_copy(bigint *bi) ++{ ++ check(bi); ++ if (bi->refs != PERMANENT) ++ bi->refs++; ++ return bi; ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Simply make a bigint object "unfreeable" if bi_free() is called on it. ++ * ++ * For this object to be freed, bi_depermanent() must be called. ++ * @param bi [in] The bigint to be made permanent. ++ */ ++void bi_permanent(bigint *bi) ++{ ++ check(bi); ++ if (bi->refs != 1) ++ { ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ return; ++ } ++ ++ bi->refs = PERMANENT; ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Take a permanent object and make it elligible for freedom. ++ * @param bi [in] The bigint to be made back to temporary. ++ */ ++void bi_depermanent(bigint *bi) ++{ ++ check(bi); ++ if (bi->refs != PERMANENT) ++ { ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ return; ++ } ++ ++ bi->refs = 1; ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Free a bigint object so it can be used again. ++ * ++ * The memory itself it not actually freed, just tagged as being available ++ * @param ctx [in] The bigint session context. ++ * @param bi [in] The bigint to be freed. ++ */ ++void bi_free(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bi) ++{ ++ check(bi); ++ if (bi->refs == PERMANENT) ++ { ++ return; ++ } ++ ++ if (--bi->refs > 0) ++ { ++ return; ++ } ++ ++ bi->next = ctx->free_list; ++ ctx->free_list = bi; ++ ctx->free_count++; ++ ++ if (--ctx->active_count < 0) ++ { ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ return; ++ } ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Convert an (unsigned) integer into a bigint. ++ * @param ctx [in] The bigint session context. ++ * @param i [in] The (unsigned) integer to be converted. ++ * ++ */ ++bigint *int_to_bi(BI_CTX *ctx, comp i) ++{ ++ bigint *biR = alloc(ctx, 1); ++ biR->comps[0] = i; ++ return biR; ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Do a full copy of the bigint object. ++ * @param ctx [in] The bigint session context. ++ * @param bi [in] The bigint object to be copied. ++ */ ++bigint *bi_clone(BI_CTX *ctx, const bigint *bi) ++{ ++ bigint *biR = alloc(ctx, bi->size); ++ check(bi); ++ memcpy(biR->comps, bi->comps, bi->size*COMP_BYTE_SIZE); ++ return biR; ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Perform an additon operation between two bigints. ++ * @param ctx [in] The bigint session context. ++ * @param bia [in] A bigint. ++ * @param bib [in] Another bigint. ++ * @return The result of the addition. ++ */ ++bigint *bi_add(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bia, bigint *bib) ++{ ++ int n; ++ comp carry = 0; ++ comp *pa, *pb; ++ ++ check(bia); ++ check(bib); ++ ++ if (bia->size > bib->size) ++ n = bia->size; ++ else ++ n = bib->size; ++ more_comps(bia, n+1); ++ more_comps(bib, n); ++ pa = bia->comps; ++ pb = bib->comps; ++ ++ do ++ { ++ comp sl, rl, cy1; ++ sl = *pa + *pb++; ++ rl = sl + carry; ++ cy1 = sl < *pa; ++ carry = cy1 | (rl < sl); ++ *pa++ = rl; ++ } while (--n != 0); ++ ++ *pa = carry; /* do overflow */ ++ bi_free(ctx, bib); ++ return trim(bia); ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Perform a subtraction operation between two bigints. ++ * @param ctx [in] The bigint session context. ++ * @param bia [in] A bigint. ++ * @param bib [in] Another bigint. ++ * @param is_negative [out] If defined, indicates that the result was negative. ++ * is_negative may be NULL. ++ * @return The result of the subtraction. The result is always positive. ++ */ ++bigint *bi_subtract(BI_CTX *ctx, ++ bigint *bia, bigint *bib, int *is_negative) ++{ ++ int n = bia->size; ++ comp *pa, *pb, carry = 0; ++ ++ check(bia); ++ check(bib); ++ ++ more_comps(bib, n); ++ pa = bia->comps; ++ pb = bib->comps; ++ ++ do ++ { ++ comp sl, rl, cy1; ++ sl = *pa - *pb++; ++ rl = sl - carry; ++ cy1 = sl > *pa; ++ carry = cy1 | (rl > sl); ++ *pa++ = rl; ++ } while (--n != 0); ++ ++ if (is_negative) /* indicate a negative result */ ++ { ++ *is_negative = carry; ++ } ++ ++ bi_free(ctx, trim(bib)); /* put bib back to the way it was */ ++ return trim(bia); ++} ++ ++/** ++ * Perform a multiply between a bigint an an (unsigned) integer ++ */ ++static bigint *bi_int_multiply(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bia, comp b) ++{ ++ int j = 0, n = bia->size; ++ bigint *biR = alloc(ctx, n + 1); ++ comp carry = 0; ++ comp *r = biR->comps; ++ comp *a = bia->comps; ++ ++ check(bia); ++ ++ /* clear things to start with */ ++ memset(r, 0, ((n+1)*COMP_BYTE_SIZE)); ++ ++ do ++ { ++ long_comp tmp = *r + (long_comp)a[j]*b + carry; ++ *r++ = (comp)tmp; /* downsize */ ++ carry = (comp)(tmp >> COMP_BIT_SIZE); ++ } while (++j < n); ++ ++ *r = carry; ++ bi_free(ctx, bia); ++ return trim(biR); ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Does both division and modulo calculations. ++ * ++ * Used extensively when doing classical reduction. ++ * @param ctx [in] The bigint session context. ++ * @param u [in] A bigint which is the numerator. ++ * @param v [in] Either the denominator or the modulus depending on the mode. ++ * @param is_mod [n] Determines if this is a normal division (0) or a reduction ++ * (1). ++ * @return The result of the division/reduction. ++ */ ++bigint *bi_divide(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *u, bigint *v, int is_mod) ++{ ++ int n = v->size, m = u->size-n; ++ int j = 0, orig_u_size = u->size; ++ uint8_t mod_offset = ctx->mod_offset; ++ comp d; ++ bigint *quotient, *tmp_u; ++ comp q_dash; ++ ++ check(u); ++ check(v); ++ ++ /* if doing reduction and we are < mod, then return mod */ ++ if (is_mod && bi_compare(v, u) > 0) ++ { ++ bi_free(ctx, v); ++ return u; ++ } ++ ++ quotient = alloc(ctx, m+1); ++ tmp_u = alloc(ctx, n+1); ++ v = trim(v); /* make sure we have no leading 0's */ ++ // d = (comp)((long_comp)COMP_RADIX/(V1+1)); ++ long_comp x = COMP_RADIX; do_div(x, V1+1); d = x; ++ ++ /* clear things to start with */ ++ memset(quotient->comps, 0, ((quotient->size)*COMP_BYTE_SIZE)); ++ ++ /* normalise */ ++ if (d > 1) ++ { ++ u = bi_int_multiply(ctx, u, d); ++ ++ if (is_mod) ++ { ++ v = ctx->bi_normalised_mod[mod_offset]; ++ } ++ else ++ { ++ v = bi_int_multiply(ctx, v, d); ++ } ++ } ++ ++ if (orig_u_size == u->size) /* new digit position u0 */ ++ { ++ more_comps(u, orig_u_size + 1); ++ } ++ ++ do ++ { ++ /* get a temporary short version of u */ ++ memcpy(tmp_u->comps, &u->comps[u->size-n-1-j], (n+1)*COMP_BYTE_SIZE); ++ ++ /* calculate q' */ ++ if (U(0) == V1) ++ { ++ q_dash = COMP_RADIX-1; ++ } ++ else ++ { ++ //q_dash = (comp)(((long_comp)U(0)*COMP_RADIX + U(1))/V1); ++ long_comp x = U(0)*COMP_RADIX + U(1); do_div(x, V1); q_dash = x; ++ ++ } ++ ++ if (v->size > 1 && V2) ++ { ++ /* we are implementing the following ++ if (V2*q_dash > (((U(0)*COMP_RADIX + U(1) - ++ q_dash*V1)*COMP_RADIX) + U(2))) ... */ ++ comp inner = (comp)((long_comp)COMP_RADIX*U(0) + U(1) - ++ (long_comp)q_dash*V1); ++ if ((long_comp)V2*q_dash > (long_comp)inner*COMP_RADIX + U(2)) ++ { ++ q_dash--; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ /* multiply and subtract */ ++ if (q_dash) ++ { ++ int is_negative; ++ tmp_u = bi_subtract(ctx, tmp_u, ++ bi_int_multiply(ctx, bi_copy(v), q_dash), &is_negative); ++ more_comps(tmp_u, n+1); ++ ++ Q(j) = q_dash; ++ ++ /* add back */ ++ if (is_negative) ++ { ++ Q(j)--; ++ tmp_u = bi_add(ctx, tmp_u, bi_copy(v)); ++ /* lop off the carry */ ++ tmp_u->size--; ++ v->size--; ++ } ++ } ++ else ++ { ++ Q(j) = 0; ++ } ++ ++ /* copy back to u */ ++ memcpy(&u->comps[u->size-n-1-j], tmp_u->comps, (n+1)*COMP_BYTE_SIZE); ++ } while (++j <= m); ++ ++ bi_free(ctx, tmp_u); ++ bi_free(ctx, v); ++ ++ if (is_mod) /* get the remainder */ ++ { ++ bi_free(ctx, quotient); ++ return bi_int_divide(ctx, trim(u), d); ++ } ++ else /* get the quotient */ ++ { ++ bi_free(ctx, u); ++ return trim(quotient); ++ } ++} ++ ++/** ++ * Perform an integer divide on a bigint. ++ */ ++static bigint *bi_int_divide(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *biR, comp denom) ++{ ++ int i = biR->size - 1; ++ long_comp r = 0; ++ ++ check(biR); ++ ++ do ++ { ++ r = (r<<COMP_BIT_SIZE) + biR->comps[i]; ++ //biR->comps[i] = (comp)(r / denom); ++ long_comp x = r; do_div(x, denom); biR->comps[i] = x; ++/* while(r > denom) ++ { ++ r -= denom; ++ }*/ ++ r%=denom; ++ } while (--i != 0); ++ ++ return trim(biR); ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Allow a binary sequence to be imported as a bigint. ++ * @param ctx [in] The bigint session context. ++ * @param data [in] The data to be converted. ++ * @param size [in] The number of bytes of data. ++ * @return A bigint representing this data. ++ */ ++bigint *bi_import(BI_CTX *ctx, const uint8_t *data, int size) ++{ ++ bigint *biR = alloc(ctx, (size+COMP_BYTE_SIZE-1)/COMP_BYTE_SIZE); ++ int i, j = 0, offset = 0; ++ ++ memset(biR->comps, 0, biR->size*COMP_BYTE_SIZE); ++ ++ for (i = size-1; i >= 0; i--) ++ { ++ biR->comps[offset] += data[i] << (j*8); ++ ++ if (++j == COMP_BYTE_SIZE) ++ { ++ j = 0; ++ offset ++; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ return trim(biR); ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Take a bigint and convert it into a byte sequence. ++ * ++ * This is useful after a decrypt operation. ++ * @param ctx [in] The bigint session context. ++ * @param x [in] The bigint to be converted. ++ * @param data [out] The converted data as a byte stream. ++ * @param size [in] The maximum size of the byte stream. Unused bytes will be ++ * zeroed. ++ */ ++void bi_export(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *x, uint8_t *data, int size) ++{ ++ int i, j, k = size-1; ++ ++ check(x); ++ memset(data, 0, size); /* ensure all leading 0's are cleared */ ++ ++ for (i = 0; i < x->size; i++) ++ { ++ for (j = 0; j < COMP_BYTE_SIZE; j++) ++ { ++ comp mask = 0xff << (j*8); ++ int num = (x->comps[i] & mask) >> (j*8); ++ data[k--] = num; ++ ++ if (k < 0) ++ { ++ break; ++ } ++ } ++ } ++ ++ bi_free(ctx, x); ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Pre-calculate some of the expensive steps in reduction. ++ * ++ * This function should only be called once (normally when a session starts). ++ * When the session is over, bi_free_mod() should be called. bi_mod_power() ++ * relies on this function being called. ++ * @param ctx [in] The bigint session context. ++ * @param bim [in] The bigint modulus that will be used. ++ * @param mod_offset [in] There are three moduluii that can be stored - the ++ * standard modulus, and it's two primes p and q. This offset refers to which ++ * modulus we are referring to. ++ * @see bi_free_mod(), bi_mod_power(). ++ */ ++void bi_set_mod(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bim, int mod_offset) ++{ ++ int k = bim->size; ++ comp d; ++// comp d = (comp)((long_comp)COMP_RADIX/(bim->comps[k-1]+1)); ++ long_comp x = COMP_RADIX; do_div(x, bim->comps[k-1]+1); d = x; ++ ++ ctx->bi_mod[mod_offset] = bim; ++ bi_permanent(ctx->bi_mod[mod_offset]); ++ ctx->bi_normalised_mod[mod_offset] = bi_int_multiply(ctx, bim, d); ++ bi_permanent(ctx->bi_normalised_mod[mod_offset]); ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Used when cleaning various bigints at the end of a session. ++ * @param ctx [in] The bigint session context. ++ * @param mod_offset [in] The offset to use. ++ * @see bi_set_mod(). ++ */ ++void bi_free_mod(BI_CTX *ctx, int mod_offset) ++{ ++ bi_depermanent(ctx->bi_mod[mod_offset]); ++ bi_free(ctx, ctx->bi_mod[mod_offset]); ++ bi_depermanent(ctx->bi_normalised_mod[mod_offset]); ++ bi_free(ctx, ctx->bi_normalised_mod[mod_offset]); ++} ++ ++/** ++ * Perform a standard multiplication between two bigints. ++ */ ++static bigint *regular_multiply(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bia, bigint *bib) ++{ ++ int i, j, i_plus_j, n = bia->size, t = bib->size; ++ bigint *biR = alloc(ctx, n + t); ++ comp *sr = biR->comps; ++ comp *sa = bia->comps; ++ comp *sb = bib->comps; ++ ++ check(bia); ++ check(bib); ++ ++ /* clear things to start with */ ++ memset(biR->comps, 0, ((n+t)*COMP_BYTE_SIZE)); ++ i = 0; ++ ++ do ++ { ++ comp carry = 0; ++ comp b = *sb++; ++ i_plus_j = i; ++ j = 0; ++ ++ do ++ { ++ long_comp tmp = sr[i_plus_j] + (long_comp)sa[j]*b + carry; ++ sr[i_plus_j++] = (comp)tmp; /* downsize */ ++ carry = (comp)(tmp >> COMP_BIT_SIZE); ++ } while (++j < n); ++ ++ sr[i_plus_j] = carry; ++ } while (++i < t); ++ ++ bi_free(ctx, bia); ++ bi_free(ctx, bib); ++ return trim(biR); ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Perform a multiplication operation between two bigints. ++ * @param ctx [in] The bigint session context. ++ * @param bia [in] A bigint. ++ * @param bib [in] Another bigint. ++ * @return The result of the multiplication. ++ */ ++bigint *bi_multiply(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bia, bigint *bib) ++{ ++ check(bia); ++ check(bib); ++ ++ return regular_multiply(ctx, bia, bib); ++} ++ ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Compare two bigints. ++ * @param bia [in] A bigint. ++ * @param bib [in] Another bigint. ++ * @return -1 if smaller, 1 if larger and 0 if equal. ++ */ ++int bi_compare(bigint *bia, bigint *bib) ++{ ++ int r, i; ++ ++ check(bia); ++ check(bib); ++ ++ if (bia->size > bib->size) ++ r = 1; ++ else if (bia->size < bib->size) ++ r = -1; ++ else ++ { ++ comp *a = bia->comps; ++ comp *b = bib->comps; ++ ++ /* Same number of components. Compare starting from the high end ++ * and working down. */ ++ r = 0; ++ i = bia->size - 1; ++ ++ do ++ { ++ if (a[i] > b[i]) ++ { ++ r = 1; ++ break; ++ } ++ else if (a[i] < b[i]) ++ { ++ r = -1; ++ break; ++ } ++ } while (--i >= 0); ++ } ++ ++ return r; ++} ++ ++/** ++ * Allocate and zero more components. Does not consume bi. ++ */ ++static void more_comps(bigint *bi, int n) ++{ ++ if (n > bi->max_comps) ++ { ++ if ((bi->max_comps * 2) > n) { ++ bi->max_comps = bi->max_comps * 2; ++ } else { ++ bi->max_comps = n; ++ } ++ bi->comps = (comp*)realloc(bi->comps, bi->max_comps * COMP_BYTE_SIZE); ++ } ++ ++ if (n > bi->size) ++ { ++ memset(&bi->comps[bi->size], 0, (n-bi->size)*COMP_BYTE_SIZE); ++ } ++ ++ bi->size = n; ++} ++ ++/* ++ * Make a new empty bigint. It may just use an old one if one is available. ++ * Otherwise get one of the heap. ++ */ ++static bigint *alloc(BI_CTX *ctx, int size) ++{ ++ bigint *biR; ++ ++ /* Can we recycle an old bigint? */ ++ if (ctx->free_list != NULL) ++ { ++ biR = ctx->free_list; ++ ctx->free_list = biR->next; ++ ctx->free_count--; ++ if (biR->refs != 0) ++ { ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ printf("%s:%s[%d]\n", __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__); ++ return 0; ++ } ++ ++ more_comps(biR, size); ++ } ++ else ++ { ++ /* No free bigints available - create a new one. */ ++ biR = (bigint *)malloc(sizeof(bigint)); ++ biR->comps = (comp*) malloc(size * COMP_BYTE_SIZE); ++ biR->max_comps = size; /* give some space to spare */ ++ } ++ ++ biR->size = size; ++ biR->refs = 1; ++ biR->next = NULL; ++ ctx->active_count++; ++ return biR; ++} ++ ++/* ++ * Work out the highest '1' bit in an exponent. Used when doing sliding-window ++ * exponentiation. ++ */ ++static int find_max_exp_index(bigint *biexp) ++{ ++ int i = COMP_BIT_SIZE-1; ++ comp shift = COMP_RADIX/2; ++ comp test = biexp->comps[biexp->size-1]; /* assume no leading zeroes */ ++ ++ check(biexp); ++ ++ do ++ { ++ if (test & shift) ++ { ++ return i+(biexp->size-1)*COMP_BIT_SIZE; ++ } ++ ++ shift >>= 1; ++ } while (--i != 0); ++ ++ return -1; /* error - must have been a leading 0 */ ++} ++ ++/* ++ * Is a particular bit is an exponent 1 or 0? Used when doing sliding-window ++ * exponentiation. ++ */ ++static int exp_bit_is_one(bigint *biexp, int offset) ++{ ++ comp test = biexp->comps[offset / COMP_BIT_SIZE]; ++ int num_shifts = offset % COMP_BIT_SIZE; ++ comp shift = 1; ++ int i; ++ ++ check(biexp); ++ ++ for (i = 0; i < num_shifts; i++) ++ { ++ shift <<= 1; ++ } ++ ++ return test & shift; ++} ++ ++/* ++ * Delete any leading 0's (and allow for 0). ++ */ ++static bigint *trim(bigint *bi) ++{ ++ check(bi); ++ ++ while (bi->comps[bi->size-1] == 0 && bi->size > 1) ++ { ++ bi->size--; ++ } ++ ++ return bi; ++} ++ ++/** ++ * @brief Perform a modular exponentiation. ++ * ++ * This function requires bi_set_mod() to have been called previously. This is ++ * one of the optimisations used for performance. ++ * @param ctx [in] The bigint session context. ++ * @param bi [in] The bigint on which to perform the mod power operation. ++ * @param biexp [in] The bigint exponent. ++ * @see bi_set_mod(). ++ */ ++bigint *bi_mod_power(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bi, bigint *biexp) ++{ ++ int i = find_max_exp_index(biexp), j, window_size = 1; ++ bigint *biR = int_to_bi(ctx, 1); ++ ++ check(bi); ++ check(biexp); ++ ++ ctx->g = (bigint **)malloc(sizeof(bigint *)); ++ ctx->g[0] = bi_clone(ctx, bi); ++ ctx->window = 1; ++ bi_permanent(ctx->g[0]); ++ ++ /* if sliding-window is off, then only one bit will be done at a time and ++ * will reduce to standard left-to-right exponentiation */ ++ do ++ { ++ if (exp_bit_is_one(biexp, i)) ++ { ++ int l = i-window_size+1; ++ int part_exp = 0; ++ ++ if (l < 0) /* LSB of exponent will always be 1 */ ++ { ++ l = 0; ++ } ++ else ++ { ++ while (exp_bit_is_one(biexp, l) == 0) ++ { ++ l++; /* go back up */ ++ } ++ } ++ ++ /* build up the section of the exponent */ ++ for (j = i; j >= l; j--) ++ { ++ biR = bi_residue(ctx, bi_square(ctx, biR)); ++ if (exp_bit_is_one(biexp, j)) ++ part_exp++; ++ ++ if (j != l) ++ part_exp <<= 1; ++ } ++ ++ part_exp = (part_exp-1)/2; /* adjust for array */ ++ biR = bi_residue(ctx, ++ bi_multiply(ctx, biR, ctx->g[part_exp])); ++ i = l-1; ++ } ++ else /* square it */ ++ { ++ biR = bi_residue(ctx, bi_square(ctx, biR)); ++ i--; ++ } ++ } while (i >= 0); ++ ++ /* cleanup */ ++ for (i = 0; i < ctx->window; i++) ++ { ++ bi_depermanent(ctx->g[i]); ++ bi_free(ctx, ctx->g[i]); ++ } ++ ++ free(ctx->g); ++ bi_free(ctx, bi); ++ bi_free(ctx, biexp); ++ return biR; ++} ++ ++/** @} */ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/bigint.h +@@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ ++/* ++ * Copyright(C) 2006 ++ * ++ * This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify ++ * it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by ++ * the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or ++ * (at your option) any later version. ++ * ++ * This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, ++ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of ++ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the ++ * GNU Lesser General Public License for more details. ++ * ++ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License ++ * along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software ++ * Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA ++ * ++ * Trimmed down from axTLS ++ * ++ * $Id: bigint.h 392 2007-06-25 16:24:51Z pablo.martin $ ++ * ++ */ ++ ++#ifndef BIGINT_HEADER ++#define BIGINT_HEADER ++ ++#define CONFIG_BIGINT_CLASSICAL 1 ++ ++#define SOCKET_READ(A,B,C) read(A,B,C) ++#define SOCKET_WRITE(A,B,C) write(A,B,C) ++#define SOCKET_CLOSE(A) close(A) ++#define TTY_FLUSH() ++ ++#include "bigint_impl.h" ++ ++#ifndef CONFIG_BIGINT_CHECK_ON ++#define check(A) /**< disappears in normal production mode */ ++#endif ++BI_CTX *bi_initialize(void); ++void bi_terminate(BI_CTX *ctx); ++void bi_permanent(bigint *bi); ++void bi_depermanent(bigint *bi); ++void bi_free(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bi); ++bigint *bi_copy(bigint *bi); ++bigint *bi_clone(BI_CTX *ctx, const bigint *bi); ++void bi_export(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bi, uint8_t *data, int size); ++bigint *bi_import(BI_CTX *ctx, const uint8_t *data, int len); ++bigint *int_to_bi(BI_CTX *ctx, comp i); ++ ++/* the functions that actually do something interesting */ ++bigint *bi_add(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bia, bigint *bib); ++bigint *bi_subtract(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bia, ++ bigint *bib, int *is_negative); ++bigint *bi_divide(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bia, bigint *bim, int is_mod); ++bigint *bi_multiply(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bia, bigint *bib); ++bigint *bi_mod_power(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bi, bigint *biexp); ++bigint *bi_mod_power2(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bi, bigint *bim, bigint *biexp); ++int bi_compare(bigint *bia, bigint *bib); ++void bi_set_mod(BI_CTX *ctx, bigint *bim, int mod_offset); ++void bi_free_mod(BI_CTX *ctx, int mod_offset); ++ ++/** ++ * @def bi_mod ++ * Find the residue of B. bi_set_mod() must be called before hand. ++ */ ++#define bi_mod(A, B) bi_divide(A, B, ctx->bi_mod[ctx->mod_offset], 1) ++ ++#define bi_residue(A, B) bi_mod(A, B) ++ ++#define bi_square(A, B) bi_multiply(A, bi_copy(B), B) ++ ++#endif ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/bigint_impl.h +@@ -0,0 +1,109 @@ ++/* ++ * Copyright(C) 2006 ++ * ++ * This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify ++ * it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by ++ * the Free Software Foundation; either version 2.1 of the License, or ++ * (at your option) any later version. ++ * ++ * This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, ++ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of ++ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the ++ * GNU Lesser General Public License for more details. ++ * ++ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License ++ * along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software ++ * Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA ++ */ ++ ++#ifndef BIGINT_IMPL_HEADER ++#define BIGINT_IMPL_HEADER ++ ++#include <linux/types.h> ++#include <common.h> ++ ++/* Maintain a number of precomputed variables when doing reduction */ ++#define BIGINT_M_OFFSET 0 /**< Normal modulo offset. */ ++#ifdef CONFIG_BIGINT_CRT ++#define BIGINT_P_OFFSET 1 /**< p modulo offset. */ ++#define BIGINT_Q_OFFSET 2 /**< q module offset. */ ++#define BIGINT_NUM_MODS 3 /**< The number of modulus constants used. */ ++#else ++#define BIGINT_NUM_MODS 1 ++#endif ++ ++/* Architecture specific functions for big ints */ ++// #ifdef WIN32 ++// #define COMP_RADIX 4294967296i64 ++// #define COMP_BIG_MSB 0x8000000000000000i64 ++// #else ++#define COMP_RADIX 4294967296ULL /**< Max component + 1 */ ++#define COMP_BIG_MSB 0x8000000000000000ULL /**< (Max dbl comp + 1)/ 2 */ ++//#endif ++#define COMP_BIT_SIZE 32 /**< Number of bits in a component. */ ++#define COMP_BYTE_SIZE 4 /**< Number of bytes in a component. */ ++#define COMP_NUM_NIBBLES 8 /**< Used For diagnostics only. */ ++ ++typedef uint32_t comp; /**< A single precision component. */ ++typedef uint64_t long_comp; /**< A double precision component. */ ++typedef int64_t slong_comp; /**< A signed double precision component. */ ++ ++/** ++ * @struct _bigint ++ * @brief A big integer basic object ++ */ ++struct _bigint ++{ ++ struct _bigint* next; /**< The next bigint in the cache. */ ++ short size; /**< The number of components in this bigint. */ ++ short max_comps; /**< The heapsize allocated for this bigint */ ++ int refs; /**< An internal reference count. */ ++ comp* comps; /**< A ptr to the actual component data */ ++}; ++ ++typedef struct _bigint bigint; /**< An alias for _bigint */ ++ ++/** ++ * Maintains the state of the cache, and a number of variables used in ++ * reduction. ++ */ ++typedef struct /**< A big integer "session" context. */ ++{ ++ bigint *active_list; /**< Bigints currently used. */ ++ bigint *free_list; /**< Bigints not used. */ ++ bigint *bi_radix; /**< The radix used. */ ++ bigint *bi_mod[BIGINT_NUM_MODS]; /**< modulus */ ++ ++#if defined(CONFIG_BIGINT_MONTGOMERY) ++ bigint *bi_RR_mod_m[BIGINT_NUM_MODS]; /**< R^2 mod m */ ++ bigint *bi_R_mod_m[BIGINT_NUM_MODS]; /**< R mod m */ ++ comp N0_dash[BIGINT_NUM_MODS]; ++#elif defined(CONFIG_BIGINT_BARRETT) ++ bigint *bi_mu[BIGINT_NUM_MODS]; /**< Storage for mu */ ++#endif ++ bigint *bi_normalised_mod[BIGINT_NUM_MODS]; /**< Normalised mod storage. */ ++ bigint **g; /**< Used by sliding-window. */ ++ int window; /**< The size of the sliding window */ ++ ++ int active_count; /**< Number of active bigints. */ ++ int free_count; /**< Number of free bigints. */ ++ ++#ifdef CONFIG_BIGINT_MONTGOMERY ++ uint8_t use_classical; /**< Use classical reduction. */ ++#endif ++ uint8_t mod_offset; /**< The mod offset we are using */ ++} BI_CTX; ++ ++#if 0 ++#define max(a,b) ((a)>(b)?(a):(b)) /**< Find the maximum of 2 numbers. */ ++#define min(a,b) ((a)<(b)?(a):(b)) /**< Find the minimum of 2 numbers. */ ++#endif ++ ++#define PERMANENT 0x7FFF55AA /**< A magic number for permanents. */ ++ ++#define V1 v->comps[v->size-1] /**< v1 for division */ ++#define V2 v->comps[v->size-2] /**< v2 for division */ ++#define U(j) tmp_u->comps[tmp_u->size-j-1] /**< uj for division */ ++#define Q(j) quotient->comps[quotient->size-j-1] /**< qj for division */ ++ ++#endif +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/div64.h +@@ -0,0 +1,113 @@ ++/* ++ * Copyright (C) 2000, 2004 Maciej W. Rozycki ++ * Copyright (C) 2003 Ralf Baechle ++ * ++ * This file is subject to the terms and conditions of the GNU General Public ++ * License. See the file "COPYING" in the main directory of this archive ++ * for more details. ++ */ ++#ifndef _ASM_DIV64_H ++#define _ASM_DIV64_H ++ ++#if (_MIPS_SZLONG == 32) ++ ++#if __GNUC__ > 3 || (__GNUC__ == 3 && __GNUC_MINOR__ >= 4) ++#define GCC_REG_ACCUM "$0" ++#else ++#define GCC_REG_ACCUM "accum" ++#endif ++ ++ ++//#include <asm/compiler.h> ++ ++/* ++ * No traps on overflows for any of these... ++ */ ++ ++#define do_div64_32(res, high, low, base) ({ \ ++ unsigned long __quot, __mod; \ ++ unsigned long __cf, __tmp, __tmp2, __i; \ ++ \ ++ __asm__(".set push\n\t" \ ++ ".set noat\n\t" \ ++ ".set noreorder\n\t" \ ++ "move %2, $0\n\t" \ ++ "move %3, $0\n\t" \ ++ "b 1f\n\t" \ ++ " li %4, 0x21\n" \ ++ "0:\n\t" \ ++ "sll $1, %0, 0x1\n\t" \ ++ "srl %3, %0, 0x1f\n\t" \ ++ "or %0, $1, %5\n\t" \ ++ "sll %1, %1, 0x1\n\t" \ ++ "sll %2, %2, 0x1\n" \ ++ "1:\n\t" \ ++ "bnez %3, 2f\n\t" \ ++ " sltu %5, %0, %z6\n\t" \ ++ "bnez %5, 3f\n" \ ++ "2:\n\t" \ ++ " addiu %4, %4, -1\n\t" \ ++ "subu %0, %0, %z6\n\t" \ ++ "addiu %2, %2, 1\n" \ ++ "3:\n\t" \ ++ "bnez %4, 0b\n\t" \ ++ " srl %5, %1, 0x1f\n\t" \ ++ ".set pop" \ ++ : "=&r" (__mod), "=&r" (__tmp), "=&r" (__quot), "=&r" (__cf), \ ++ "=&r" (__i), "=&r" (__tmp2) \ ++ : "Jr" (base), "0" (high), "1" (low)); \ ++ \ ++ (res) = __quot; \ ++ __mod; }) ++ ++#define do_div(n, base) ({ \ ++ unsigned long long __quot; \ ++ unsigned long __mod; \ ++ unsigned long long __div; \ ++ unsigned long __upper, __low, __high, __base; \ ++ \ ++ __div = (n); \ ++ __base = (base); \ ++ \ ++ __high = __div >> 32; \ ++ __low = __div; \ ++ __upper = __high; \ ++ \ ++ if (__high) \ ++ __asm__("divu $0, %z2, %z3" \ ++ : "=h" (__upper), "=l" (__high) \ ++ : "Jr" (__high), "Jr" (__base) \ ++ : GCC_REG_ACCUM); \ ++ \ ++ __mod = do_div64_32(__low, __upper, __low, __base); \ ++ \ ++ __quot = __high; \ ++ __quot = __quot << 32 | __low; \ ++ (n) = __quot; \ ++ __mod; }) ++#endif /* (_MIPS_SZLONG == 32) */ ++ ++#if (_MIPS_SZLONG == 64) ++ ++/* ++ * Hey, we're already 64-bit, no ++ * need to play games.. ++ */ ++#define do_div(n, base) ({ \ ++ unsigned long __quot; \ ++ unsigned int __mod; \ ++ unsigned long __div; \ ++ unsigned int __base; \ ++ \ ++ __div = (n); \ ++ __base = (base); \ ++ \ ++ __mod = __div % __base; \ ++ __quot = __div / __base; \ ++ \ ++ (n) = __quot; \ ++ __mod; }) ++ ++#endif /* (_MIPS_SZLONG == 64) */ ++ ++#endif /* _ASM_DIV64_H */ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/dump_key.c +@@ -0,0 +1,29 @@ ++#include <stdio.h> ++#include <stdlib.h> ++#include <sys/types.h> ++#include <sys/stat.h> ++#include <unistd.h> ++ ++int main(int argc, char **argv) ++{ ++ FILE *fp = fopen("public_fon_rsa_key_6.pem", "r"); ++ struct stat s; ++ unsigned char *b; ++ int i; ++ if(!fp) ++ return 1; ++ stat("public_fon_rsa_key_6.pem", &s); ++ b = malloc(s.st_size); ++ fread(b, s.st_size, 1, fp); ++ fclose(fp); ++ printf("unsigned char public_key[] = {\n\t"); ++ for(i = 0;i < s.st_size; i++) ++ { ++ printf("0x%02X,", b[i]); ++ if(i%16 == 15) ++ printf("\n\t"); ++ } ++ printf("};\n"); ++// printf("\n%d %d\n", i, s.st_size); ++ return 0; ++} +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/foncheckrsa.c +@@ -0,0 +1,79 @@ ++/* ++ * RSA + RIPEMD160 signature verification command ++ * ++ * Copyright (C) 2007 FON Wireless Ltd. ++ * ++ * This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or ++ * modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License ++ * as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 ++ * of the License, or (at your option) any later version. ++ * ++ * This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, ++ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of ++ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the ++ * GNU General Public License for more details. ++ * ++ * You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License ++ * along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software ++ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. ++ * ++ * Created: 20060728 Pablo MartÃn Medrano <pablo@fon.com> ++ * ++ * $Id: foncheckrsa.c 332 2007-05-02 09:45:54Z pablo.martin $ ++ */ ++#include <stdio.h> ++#include <stdlib.h> ++#include <sys/types.h> ++#include <sys/stat.h> ++#include <fcntl.h> ++#include <string.h> ++#include <errno.h> ++#include <unistd.h> ++#include "fonrsa.h" ++ ++int main(int argc, char **argv) ++{ ++ int fd, i; ++ FONRSA_ERROR fonrsa_error; ++ void *handle; ++ ++ if (argc != 4) { ++ fprintf(stderr, " Usage: foncheckrsa [public_key.der] [signature] [file]\n"); ++ fprintf(stderr, " Pablo MartÃn Medrano <pablo@fon.com>\n"); ++ fprintf(stderr, " RIPEMD-160 software written by Antoon Bosselaers,\n"); ++ fprintf(stderr, " available at http://www.esat.kuleuven.be/~cosicart/ps/AB-9601/.\n"); ++ fprintf(stderr, " Uses the axTLS library bigint implementation (libfonrsa)\n"); ++ fprintf(stderr, " http://www.leroc.com.au/axTLS/\n"); ++ return -1; ++ } ++ /* Check the existence of input files */ ++ for (i = 1; i < 4; i++) { ++ if ((fd = open(argv[i], O_RDONLY)) == -1) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error: opening \"%s\": %s\n", argv[i], ++ strerror(errno)); ++ fprintf(stderr, "Bailing out..."); ++ exit(-2); ++ } ++ close(fd); ++ } ++ handle = FR_init(argv[1]); ++ if (handle == NULL) { ++ printf("Error loading keys in %s\n", argv[1]); ++ return 1; ++ } ++ fonrsa_error = FR_verify_file(handle, argv[3], argv[2]); ++ FR_end(handle); ++ switch (fonrsa_error) { ++ case FONRSA_OK: ++ printf("Verified OK\n"); ++ return 0; ++ case FONRSA_VERIFICATION_FAILURE: ++ printf("Verification failure\n"); ++ return 1; ++ default: ++ printf("Verification error\n"); ++ return -1; ++ } ++ return -1; ++} ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/fonrsa.c +@@ -0,0 +1,584 @@ ++/* ++ * FONSM RSA handling library ++ * ++ * This file is part of FONUCS. Copyright (C) 2007 FON Wireless Ltd. ++ * ++ * This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify ++ * it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by ++ * the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or ++ * (at your option) any later version. ++ * ++ * This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, ++ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of ++ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the ++ * GNU Lesser General Public License for more details. ++ * ++ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License ++ * along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software ++ * Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA ++ * ++ * Created: 20070306 Pablo Martin Medrano <pablo@fon.com> ++ * ++ * Based on axTLS ++ * ++ * $Id: fonrsa.c 405 2007-09-19 15:26:17Z jesus.pico $ ++ */ ++#include <sys/types.h> ++#include <stdlib.h> ++#include <stdio.h> ++#include <string.h> ++#include <sys/types.h> ++#include <sys/stat.h> ++#include <fcntl.h> ++#include <unistd.h> ++#include <errno.h> ++#include "rmd160.h" ++#include "bigint.h" ++#include "fonrsa.h" ++#include "base64.h" ++ ++typedef struct { ++ uint8_t *buffer; ++ size_t size; ++} DER_key; ++ ++typedef struct { ++ bigint *m; /* modulus */ ++ bigint *e; /* public exponent */ ++ int num_octets; ++ BI_CTX *bi_ctx; /* big integer handle */ ++} RSA_parameters; ++ ++typedef struct { ++ DER_key *derkey; ++ RSA_parameters *rsaparms; ++} RSA; ++ ++static uint8_t *CH_load_raw_file(char *filename, size_t *size); ++static DER_key *CH_load_der_key(char *filename); ++static void CH_free_der_key(DER_key *key); ++static int asn1_get_public_key(const uint8_t *buf, int len, RSA_parameters **rsa_parameters); ++void CH_pub_key_new(RSA_parameters **rsa_parameters, const uint8_t *modulus, int mod_len, const uint8_t *pub_exp, int pub_len); ++int CH_decrypt(RSA_parameters *rsa, uint8_t *buffer_in, uint8_t *buffer_out); ++byte *RMDbinary(char *fname); ++int CH_get_rmd160_hash_from_signature(byte *hash, char *signature_file, char *public_key_file); ++static unsigned char *load_file_in_buffer(char *path, int *size); ++static int save_file_from_buffer(char *path, unsigned char *buffer, int size); ++int ExtractPadding(uint8_t* OutputBuffer, uint8_t* InputBuffer, int LengthOfInputBuffer); ++ ++#define RMDsize 160 /* A RIPEMD-160 hash has 160 bits */ ++ ++/* ++ * returns RMD(message in file fname) fname is read as binary data. ++ * non-reentrant ++ */ ++byte *RMDbinary(char *fname) ++{ ++ FILE *mf; /* pointer to file <fname> */ ++ byte data[1024]; /* contains current mess. block */ ++ dword nbytes; /* length of this block */ ++ dword MDbuf[RMDsize / 32]; /* contains (A, B, C, D(, E)) */ ++ static byte hashcode[RMDsize / 8]; /* for final hash-value */ ++ dword X[16]; /* current 16-word chunk */ ++ unsigned int i, j; /* counters */ ++ dword length[2]; /* length in bytes of message */ ++ dword offset; /* # of unprocessed bytes at */ ++ /* call of MDfinish */ ++ ++ /* initialize */ ++ if ((mf = fopen(fname, "rb")) == NULL) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "\nRMDbinary: cannot open file \"%s\".\n", ++ fname); ++ exit(1); ++ } ++ MDinit(MDbuf); ++ length[0] = 0; ++ length[1] = 0; ++ while ((nbytes = fread(data, 1, 1024, mf)) != 0) { ++ /* process all complete blocks */ ++ for (i = 0; i < (nbytes >> 6); i++) { ++ for (j = 0; j < 16; j++) ++ X[j] = BYTES_TO_DWORD(data + 64 * i + 4 * j); ++ compress(MDbuf, X); ++ } ++ /* update length[] */ ++ if (length[0] + nbytes < length[0]) ++ length[1]++; /* overflow to msb of length */ ++ length[0] += nbytes; ++ } ++ /* finish: */ ++ offset = length[0] & 0x3C0; /* extract bytes 6 to 10 inclusive */ ++ MDfinish(MDbuf, data + offset, length[0], length[1]); ++ ++ for (i = 0; i < RMDsize / 8; i += 4) { ++ hashcode[i] = MDbuf[i >> 2]; ++ hashcode[i + 1] = (MDbuf[i >> 2] >> 8); ++ hashcode[i + 2] = (MDbuf[i >> 2] >> 16); ++ hashcode[i + 3] = (MDbuf[i >> 2] >> 24); ++ } ++ fclose(mf); ++ ++ return (byte *) hashcode; ++} ++byte *RMDbinary_buffer(char *buffer, int size_buffer) ++{ ++ return NULL; ++} ++ ++/* ++ * Extracts the RMD 160 hash from the signature file ++ */ ++int CH_get_rmd160_hash_from_signature(byte *hash, char *signature_file, char *public_key_file) ++{ ++ RSA_parameters *rsa_parameters; ++ DER_key *derkey; ++ uint8_t *signature; ++ size_t signature_size; ++ uint8_t *decrypted; ++ ++ signature = CH_load_raw_file(signature_file, &signature_size); ++ if ((signature == NULL)||(signature_size != 512)) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error: Loading signature key '%s'\n", signature_file); ++ exit(-1); ++ } ++ derkey = CH_load_der_key(public_key_file); ++ if (derkey == NULL) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error: opening DER key file '%s'\n", public_key_file); ++ exit(-1); ++ } ++ if ((asn1_get_public_key(derkey->buffer, derkey->size, &rsa_parameters)) != 0) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error: Extracting public key from DER file\n"); ++ exit(-1); ++ } ++ CH_free_der_key(derkey); ++ if (rsa_parameters->num_octets != 512) ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error: The RSA public key size is not 4096 bits %d\n", rsa_parameters->num_octets); ++ decrypted = (uint8_t *)malloc(rsa_parameters->num_octets); ++ if (CH_decrypt(rsa_parameters, signature, decrypted)) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error: Decrypting signature\n"); ++ exit(-1); ++ } ++ memcpy(hash, decrypted + 492, 20); ++ free(decrypted); ++ free(signature); ++ return 0; ++} ++ ++/* ++ * Decrypts the signature buffer using the rsa public key loaded ++ */ ++int CH_decrypt(RSA_parameters *rsa, uint8_t *buffer_in, uint8_t *buffer_out) ++{ ++ bigint *dat_bi; ++ bigint *decrypted_bi; ++ int byte_size; ++ ++ byte_size = rsa->num_octets; ++ dat_bi = bi_import(rsa->bi_ctx, buffer_in, byte_size); ++ rsa->bi_ctx->mod_offset = BIGINT_M_OFFSET; ++ bi_copy(rsa->m); ++ decrypted_bi = bi_mod_power(rsa->bi_ctx, dat_bi, rsa->e); ++ bi_export(rsa->bi_ctx, decrypted_bi, buffer_out, byte_size); ++ return 0; ++} ++/* ++ * Loads a file in a uint8_t buffer ++ */ ++static uint8_t *CH_load_raw_file(char *filename, size_t *size) ++{ ++ struct stat st; ++ int fd; ++ ssize_t br; ++ uint8_t *ret; ++ ++ if ((stat(filename, &st)) == -1) ++ return NULL; ++ if ((ret = (uint8_t *)malloc(st.st_size)) == NULL) ++ return NULL; ++ fd = open(filename, O_RDONLY); ++ if (fd == -1) { ++ free(ret); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ br = read(fd, ret, st.st_size); ++ close(fd); ++ if (br != st.st_size) { ++ free(ret); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ *size = st.st_size; ++ return ret; ++} ++/* ++ * Loads a .der file in a buffer ++ */ ++static DER_key *CH_load_der_key(char *filename) ++{ ++ DER_key *ret; ++ ++ if ((ret = (DER_key *)malloc(sizeof(DER_key))) == NULL) ++ return NULL; ++ if ((ret->buffer = CH_load_raw_file(filename, &(ret->size))) == NULL) { ++ free(ret); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ return ret; ++} ++/* ++ * CH_load_pem_key ++ */ ++static DER_key *CH_load_pem_key(char *filename) ++{ ++ DER_key *ret; ++ uint8_t *buffer; ++ char *b64,*p,*t; ++ char key[1024]; ++ size_t filesize; ++ int size; ++ ++ if ((ret = (DER_key *)malloc(sizeof(DER_key))) == NULL) ++ return NULL; ++ if ((buffer = CH_load_raw_file(filename, &filesize)) == NULL) { ++ free(ret); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ p = (char *)buffer; ++ while ((*p != '\n') && (*p != '\0')) ++ p++; ++ if (*p == '\0') { ++ free(ret); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ p++; ++ b64 = t = p; ++ while((p - b64) <= filesize) { ++ if ((*p == '-')) { ++ break; ++ } else if ((*p != '\n') && (*p != ' ') && (*p != '\t')) { ++ *t = *p; ++ t++; ++ } ++ p++; ++ } ++ *t = '\0'; ++ size = B64_decode(b64, key, strlen(b64), 1024); ++ if (size < 0) { ++ free(buffer); ++ free(ret); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ free(buffer); ++ ret->buffer = (char *)malloc(size); ++ ret->size = size; ++ memcpy((void *)ret->buffer, (void *)key, size); ++ return ret; ++} ++ ++/* ++ * CH_free_der_key ++ */ ++static void CH_free_der_key(DER_key *key) ++{ ++ free(key->buffer); ++ free(key); ++} ++ ++/* ++ * Get the public key specifics from an ASN.1 encoded file ++ * A function lacking in the exported axTLS API ++ * ++ * This is a really weird hack that only works with RSA public key ++ * files ++ */ ++static int asn1_get_public_key(const uint8_t *buf, int len, RSA_parameters **rsa_parameters) ++{ ++ uint8_t *modulus, *pub_exp; ++ int mod_len, pub_len; ++ ++ pub_len = 3; ++ mod_len = len - 37; ++ if (buf[0] != 0x30) { ++ return -1; ++ } ++ ++ pub_exp = (uint8_t *)malloc(3); ++ modulus = (uint8_t *)malloc(mod_len); ++ memcpy(modulus, buf + 32 , mod_len); ++ memcpy(pub_exp, buf + 34 + mod_len, 3); ++ if (mod_len <= 0 || pub_len <= 0 ) ++ return -1; ++ CH_pub_key_new(rsa_parameters, modulus, mod_len, pub_exp, pub_len); ++ ++ free(modulus); ++ free(pub_exp); ++ return 0; ++} ++ ++/* ++ * Similar to RSA_pub_key_new, rewritten to make this program depend only on bi module ++ */ ++void CH_pub_key_new(RSA_parameters **rsa, const uint8_t *modulus, int mod_len, const uint8_t *pub_exp, int pub_len) ++{ ++ RSA_parameters *rsa_parameters; ++ ++ BI_CTX *bi_ctx = bi_initialize(); ++ *rsa = (RSA_parameters *)calloc(1, sizeof(RSA_parameters)); ++ rsa_parameters = *rsa; ++ rsa_parameters->bi_ctx = bi_ctx; ++ rsa_parameters->num_octets = (mod_len & 0xFFF0); ++ rsa_parameters->m = bi_import(bi_ctx, modulus, mod_len); ++ bi_set_mod(bi_ctx, rsa_parameters->m, BIGINT_M_OFFSET); ++ rsa_parameters->e = bi_import(bi_ctx, pub_exp, pub_len); ++ bi_permanent(rsa_parameters->e); ++} ++ ++static unsigned char *load_file_in_buffer(char *path, int *size) ++{ ++ unsigned char *buffer; ++ struct stat st; ++ int fd; ++ ++ if (stat(path, &st)) ++ return NULL; ++ buffer = (unsigned char *)malloc(st.st_size); ++ if (buffer == NULL) ++ return NULL; ++ if ((fd = open(path, O_RDONLY)) == -1) { ++ free(buffer); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ if (read(fd, (void *)buffer,st.st_size) != (ssize_t)st.st_size) { ++ free(buffer); ++ close(fd); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ *size = (int)st.st_size; ++ close(fd); ++ return buffer; ++} ++ ++static int save_file_from_buffer(char *path, unsigned char *buffer, int size) ++{ ++ int fd; ++ ++ if ((fd = open(path, O_WRONLY | O_CREAT, 0644)) == -1) ++ return -1; ++ if (write(fd, buffer, (size_t)size) != ((ssize_t)size)) { ++ close(fd); ++ return -1; ++ } ++ close(fd); ++ return 0; ++} ++ ++/* FR_init */ ++void *FR_init(char *public_key_path) ++{ ++ DER_key *derkey; ++ RSA_parameters *rsa_parameters; ++ char *ending; ++ ++ ending = public_key_path + strlen(public_key_path) - 3; ++ if (!strcmp(ending, "der")) ++ derkey = CH_load_der_key(public_key_path); ++ else if (!strcmp(ending, "pem")) ++ derkey = CH_load_pem_key(public_key_path); ++ else { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error: unknown key format\n"); ++ exit(-1); ++ } ++ if (derkey == NULL) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error: opening key file '%s'\n", public_key_path); ++ exit(-1); ++ } ++ if ((asn1_get_public_key(derkey->buffer, derkey->size, &rsa_parameters)) != 0) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error: Extracting public key from file\n"); ++ exit(-1); ++ } ++ CH_free_der_key(derkey); ++ return (void *)rsa_parameters; ++} ++ ++/* FR_end */ ++FONRSA_ERROR FR_end(void *handle) ++{ ++ RSA_parameters *rsa_parameters = (RSA_parameters *)handle; ++ ++ free(rsa_parameters); ++ return FONRSA_OK; ++} ++ ++/* FR_decrypt_buffer */ ++FONRSA_ERROR FR_decrypt_buffer(void *handler, unsigned char *cryptext, int cryptext_size, ++ unsigned char *plaintext, int plaintext_buffer_size, int *plaintext_size) ++{ ++ RSA_parameters *rsaparms = (RSA_parameters *)handler; ++ ++ if (cryptext_size != rsaparms->num_octets) { ++ return FONRSA_SIZE; ++ } ++ if (plaintext_buffer_size < cryptext_size) { ++ return FONRSA_SIZE; ++ } ++ if (CH_decrypt(rsaparms, (uint8_t *)cryptext, (uint8_t *)plaintext)) { ++ return FONRSA_DECRYPT; ++ } ++ *plaintext_size = cryptext_size; ++ return FONRSA_OK; ++} ++ ++FONRSA_ERROR FR_decrypt_buffer_v2(void *handler, unsigned char *cryptext, int cryptext_size, ++ unsigned char *plaintext, int plaintext_buffer_size, int *plaintext_size) ++{ ++ unsigned char* AuxBuffer; ++ int AuxSize; ++ ++ AuxBuffer = (unsigned char*)malloc(cryptext_size); ++ ++ RSA_parameters *rsaparms = (RSA_parameters *)handler; ++ ++ if (cryptext_size != rsaparms->num_octets) { ++ return FONRSA_SIZE; ++ } ++ if (plaintext_buffer_size < cryptext_size) { ++ return FONRSA_SIZE; ++ } ++ if (CH_decrypt(rsaparms, (uint8_t *)cryptext, (uint8_t *)AuxBuffer)) { ++ return FONRSA_DECRYPT; ++ } ++ if ((AuxSize = ExtractPadding((uint8_t*)plaintext, (uint8_t*)AuxBuffer, cryptext_size)) < 0) ++ { ++ printf("Incorrect Padding decrypting buffer"); ++ return FONRSA_DECRYPT; ++ } ++ *plaintext_size = AuxSize; ++ return FONRSA_OK; ++} ++ ++/* ++ * ++ * Implementation of PKCS 1.5 padding, borrowed from ++ * Tom's code (public domain) ++ */ ++ ++/* Standalone FR_verify_file */ ++FONRSA_ERROR FR_verify_file(void *handler, char *file_path, char *signature_file_path) ++{ ++ int j; ++ byte *hashcode; ++ byte hash[20]; ++ uint8_t *decrypted; ++ RSA_parameters *rsa_parameters = (RSA_parameters *)handler; ++ char *signature_buffer; ++ int signature_size; ++ ++ /* Calculates the RIPEMD-160 hash of the file */ ++ hashcode = RMDbinary (file_path); ++ /* Decrypts the signature file using the RSA public key */ ++ signature_buffer = load_file_in_buffer(signature_file_path, &signature_size); ++ if (signature_buffer == NULL) ++ return FONRSA_OPENKEY; ++ ++ if (rsa_parameters->num_octets != signature_size) ++ return FONRSA_SIZE; ++ decrypted = (uint8_t *)malloc(rsa_parameters->num_octets); ++ if (CH_decrypt(rsa_parameters, signature_buffer, decrypted)) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error: Decrypting signature\n"); ++ exit(-1); ++ } ++ memcpy(hash, decrypted + 492, 20); ++ free(decrypted); ++ free(signature_buffer); ++ for (j = 0; j < RMDsize/8; j++) { ++ if (hash[j] != hashcode[j]) ++ return FONRSA_VERIFICATION_FAILURE; ++ } ++ return FONRSA_OK; ++} ++ ++/* FR_decrypt_file */ ++FONRSA_ERROR FR_decrypt_file(void *handle, char *crypted_file_path, char *plaintext_file_path) ++{ ++ int size; ++ FONRSA_ERROR ret; ++ char *filebuffer; ++ char crypted[1024]; ++ int crypted_size; ++ ++ if ((filebuffer = load_file_in_buffer(crypted_file_path, &size)) == NULL) { ++ return FONRSA_LOADFILE; ++ } ++ ++ ret = FR_decrypt_buffer(handle, filebuffer, size, crypted, 1024, &crypted_size); ++ if (ret != FONRSA_OK) { ++ free(filebuffer); ++ return ret; ++ } ++ free(filebuffer); ++ ++ if (save_file_from_buffer(plaintext_file_path, crypted, crypted_size)) { ++ printf("Error writing %lu bytes into %s", crypted_size, plaintext_file_path); ++ return FONRSA_SAVEFILE; ++ } ++ return FONRSA_OK; ++} ++ ++int ExtractPadding(uint8_t* OutputBuffer, uint8_t* InputBuffer, int LengthOfInputBuffer) ++{ ++ int i; ++ ++ //First typical checks... ++ if (LengthOfInputBuffer < MINIMUM_PADING_BYTES_PKCS_1_5) ++ { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error:ExtractPadding: Error, Length of input buffer is too short.\n"); ++ return -1; ++ } ++ else if((InputBuffer[0] != 0) || (InputBuffer[1] > 2)) //Necessary header of Padding... ++ { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error:ExtractPadding: Error, Padding header is incorrect.\n"); ++ return -1; ++ } ++ for (i=2; i < LengthOfInputBuffer; i++) //Variable size of non-zero padding.... ++ { ++ if (InputBuffer[i] == 0) break; //This is the end of Padding. ++ } ++ //We need to evaluate if there is an existing message... ++ if (i < LengthOfInputBuffer - 2) ++ {//Ok, Padding is extracted... copying the message and finishing... ++ memcpy(OutputBuffer, &(InputBuffer[i + 1]), LengthOfInputBuffer - (i + 1)); ++ return LengthOfInputBuffer - (i + 1); ++ } ++ //If we have reached to this point, then an error has occurred... ++ return -1; ++} ++ ++#ifdef __MAINTEST__ ++int main(int argc, char **argv) ++{ ++ void *handle = NULL; ++ FONRSA_ERROR ret; ++ char *filebuffer = NULL; ++ char crypted[1024]; ++ int size, crypted_size; ++ ++ if (argc != 4) { ++ printf("Usage: %s <key_file> <crypted_file> <output_file>\n", argv[0]); ++ return 1; ++ } ++ ++ handle = FR_init(argv[1]); ++ if (handle == NULL) { ++ printf("Error loading keys\n"); ++ return 1; ++ } ++ ret = FR_decrypt_file(handle, argv[2], argv[3]); ++ if (ret != FONRSA_OK) { ++ printf("FR_decrypt_file returns %d\n", ret); ++ } ++ FR_end(handle); ++ return (int)ret; ++} ++ ++#endif ++ ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/fonrsa.h +@@ -0,0 +1,53 @@ ++/* ++ * FONSM RSA handling library, used by fonsmcd and foncheckrsa ++ * ++ * This file is part of FONUCS. Copyright (C) 2007 FON Wireless Ltd. ++ * ++ * This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify ++ * it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by ++ * the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or ++ * (at your option) any later version. ++ * ++ * This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, ++ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of ++ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the ++ * GNU Lesser General Public License for more details. ++ * ++ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License ++ * along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software ++ * Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA ++ * ++ * Created: 20070306 Pablo Martin Medrano <pablo@fon.com> ++ * ++ * $Id: fonrsa.h 404 2007-09-17 10:41:31Z jesus.pico $ ++ */ ++#ifndef _FONRSA_H ++#define _FONRSA_H ++ ++#define MINIMUM_PADING_BYTES_PKCS_1_5 3 ++ ++typedef enum { ++ FONRSA_OK = 0, ++ FONRSA_VERIFICATION_FAILURE = 1, ++ FONRSA_OPENKEY = 2, ++ FONRSA_SIZE = 3, ++ FONRSA_LOADFILE = 4, ++ FONRSA_CRYPT = 5, ++ FONRSA_DECRYPT = 6, ++ FONRSA_SAVEFILE = 7, ++ FONRSA_NOSYS = 8, ++ FONRSA_VERIFY = 9 ++} FONRSA_ERROR; ++ ++void *FR_init(char *public_key_path); ++FONRSA_ERROR FR_end(void *handle); ++FONRSA_ERROR FR_decrypt_buffer(void *handler, unsigned char *cryptext, int cryptext_size, ++ unsigned char *plaintext, int plaintext_buffer_size, int *plaintext_size); ++FONRSA_ERROR FR_decrypt_buffer_v2(void *handler, unsigned char *cryptext, int cryptext_size, ++ unsigned char *plaintext, int plaintext_buffer_size, int *plaintext_size); ++FONRSA_ERROR FR_verify_file(void *handler, char *file_path, char *signature_file_path); ++FONRSA_ERROR FR_decrypt_file(void *handler, char *crypted_file_path, char *plaintext_file_path); ++ ++#endif ++ ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/log.c +@@ -0,0 +1,138 @@ ++/* ++ * Fonsm log module. Used inside the fonsm backend module and on the client. ++ * ++ * This file is part of FONUCS. Copyright (C) 2007 FON Wireless Ltd. ++ * ++ * Created: 20070202 Pablo Martin Medrano <pablo@fon.com> ++ * ++ * $Id: log.c 392 2007-06-25 16:24:51Z pablo.martin $ ++ */ ++#include <stdio.h> ++#include <string.h> ++#include <stdlib.h> ++#include <stdarg.h> ++#include <unistd.h> ++#ifndef WIN32 ++#include <syslog.h> ++#endif ++#include "log.h" ++ ++#define MAX_SESSION_PREFIX 256 ++ ++typedef struct { ++ char domain[256]; ++ LG_LEVEL watermark; ++ int mode; ++ LG_log_function_pointer function; ++} ST_fslog; ++ ++static ST_fslog fslog; ++static void LG_log_string(LG_LEVEL level, const char *message); ++ ++/*! ++ \brief Starts the log subsystem, redirecting glog() to stderr/syslog depending ++ on mode ++ \retval FSLOG_ERROR : FSLOG_OK if everything goes well ++ \param lg : handle that will be returned ++ \param ident : program identifier, any string ++ \param low_watermark : if the log level is less than this value, it will not be logged ++ \param mode : FSLOG_MODE_SYSLOG (log to syslog) or FSLOG_MODE_STDERR (log to stderr) ++*/ ++FSLOG_ERROR LG_start(const char *domain, LG_LEVEL watermark, int mode, ++ LG_log_function_pointer log_function, int facility) ++{ ++#ifndef WIN32 ++ strncpy(fslog.domain, domain, MAX_LG_DOMAIN); ++ fslog.domain[MAX_LG_DOMAIN - 1] = '\0'; ++ fslog.watermark = watermark; ++ fslog.mode = mode; ++ fslog.function = log_function?log_function:LG_log_string; ++ if (fslog.mode & LG_SYSLOG) ++ openlog(domain, LOG_NDELAY, facility); ++ return FSLOG_OK; ++#else ++ return FSLOG_OK; ++#endif ++} ++ ++/*! ++ \brief Set the low watermark ++ \retval FSLOG_ERROR : FSLOG_OK ++ \param lg : log handle ++ \param low_watermark : new watermark ++*/ ++FSLOG_ERROR LG_set_loglevel(LG_LEVEL watermark) ++{ ++ fslog.watermark = watermark; ++ return FSLOG_OK; ++} ++ ++/*! ++ \brief Ends the log subsystem, unregisteing glog handle ++ \retval FSLOG_ERROR : FSLOG_OK if everything goes well ++ \param handle : log handle to free ++*/ ++FSLOG_ERROR LG_end(void) ++{ ++#ifndef WIN32 ++ if (fslog.mode & LG_SYSLOG) ++ closelog(); ++#endif ++ return FSLOG_OK; ++} ++ ++ ++void LG_log(LG_LEVEL loglevel, const char *message, ...) ++{ ++#ifndef WIN32 ++ va_list ap; ++ char buffer[4096]; ++ int n; ++ ++ va_start(ap, message); ++ n = vsnprintf(buffer, MAX_LOG_STRING, message, ap); ++ va_end(ap); ++ if (n > -1 && n < MAX_LOG_STRING) ++ fslog.function(loglevel, buffer); ++ else ++ fon_critical("%s: Message too big to be logged", __FUNCTION__); ++#else ++ return; ++#endif ++} ++ ++/* Default log function (when mode is LG_SYSLOG or LG_STDERR) */ ++static void LG_log_string(LG_LEVEL level, const char *message) ++{ ++#ifndef WIN32 ++ static struct { ++ int syslog_level; ++ char *log_string; ++ } fonlog_to_syslog[] = { ++ [LG_DEBUG] = {LOG_ERR, "DEBUG"}, ++ [LG_MESSAGE] = {LOG_ERR, "MESSAGE"}, ++ [LG_WARNING] = {LOG_ERR, "WARNING"}, ++ [LG_CRITICAL] = {LOG_ERR, "CRITICAL"}, ++ [LG_ERROR] = {LOG_ERR, "ERROR"} ++ }; ++ ++ if (level < fslog.watermark) ++ return; ++ if (fslog.mode & LG_SYSLOG) { ++ if (level == LG_MESSAGE) { ++ syslog(LOG_INFO, "%s", message); ++ } else { ++ syslog(fonlog_to_syslog[level].syslog_level, "%s: %s", fonlog_to_syslog[level].log_string, message); ++ } ++ } ++ if (fslog.mode & LG_STDERR) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "%s[%d]: %8.8s: %s\n", fslog.domain, ++ getpid(), fonlog_to_syslog[level].log_string, ++ message); ++ } ++#else ++ /* FIXE: todo */ ++ return; ++#endif ++} ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/log.h +@@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ ++/* ++ * Fonsm log module. Used inside the fonsm backend module and on the client. ++ * ++ * This file is part of FONUCS. Copyright (C) 2007 FON Wireless Ltd. ++ * ++ * Created: 20070202 Pablo Martin Medrano <pablo@fon.com> ++ * ++ * $Id: log.h 379 2007-05-28 09:17:48Z pablo.martin $ ++ */ ++#ifndef _LOG_H ++#define _LOG_H ++ ++#ifdef __cplusplus ++extern "C" { ++#endif ++ ++#include <stdarg.h> ++ ++typedef enum { ++ FSLOG_OK = 0, ++ FSLOG_UNKNOWN = -1 ++} FSLOG_ERROR; ++ ++ ++typedef void * LG_HANDLE; ++ ++typedef enum { ++ LG_DEBUG = 0, ++ LG_MESSAGE = 1, ++ LG_INFO = 2, ++ LG_WARNING = 3, ++ LG_CRITICAL = 4, ++ LG_ERROR = 5 ++} LG_LEVEL; ++ ++#define LG_SYSLOG 0x01 ++#define LG_STDERR 0x02 ++#define LG_CUSTOM 0x04 ++ ++#define MAX_LG_DOMAIN 256 ++#define MAX_LOG_STRING 4096 ++ ++#ifndef NDEBUG ++#ifndef LOGPRINTF ++#define fon_debug(...) LG_log (LG_DEBUG, __VA_ARGS__) ++#else ++#define fon_debug(...) { printf("DEBUG: "); printf(__VA_ARGS__); printf("\n"); } ++#endif ++#else ++/* fon_debug evaluates to nothing when NDEBUG is defined */ ++#define fon_debug(...) ++#endif ++#ifndef LOGPRINTF ++#define fon_message(...) LG_log (LG_MESSAGE, __VA_ARGS__) ++#define fon_warning(...) LG_log (LG_WARNING, __VA_ARGS__) ++#define fon_critical(...) LG_log (LG_CRITICAL, __VA_ARGS__) ++#define fon_error(...) LG_log (LG_ERROR, __VA_ARGS__) ++#else ++#define fon_message(...) { printf("MESSAGE: "); printf(__VA_ARGS__); printf("\n"); } ++#define fon_warning(...) { printf("WARNING: "); printf(__VA_ARGS__); printf("\n"); } ++#define fon_critical(...) { printf("CRITICAL: "); printf(__VA_ARGS__); printf("\n"); } ++#define fon_error(...) { printf("ERROR: "); printf(__VA_ARGS__); printf("\n"); } ++#endif ++ ++typedef void (*LG_log_function_pointer)(LG_LEVEL level, const char *message); ++ ++FSLOG_ERROR LG_start(const char *domain, LG_LEVEL watermark, int mode, LG_log_function_pointer log_function, int facility); ++FSLOG_ERROR LG_set_loglevel(LG_LEVEL watermark); ++FSLOG_ERROR LG_end(void); ++void LG_log(LG_LEVEL loglevel, const char *message, ...); ++ ++#ifdef __cplusplus ++} ++#endif ++ ++#endif ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/Makefile +@@ -0,0 +1,31 @@ ++# ++# FONRSA & FONSIGN libraries unit testing ++# ++# This file is part of FONUCS. Copyright (C) 2007 FON Wireless Ltd. ++# ++# Execute in this directory ++# ++# Created: 20070422 Pablo Martin Medrano <pablo@fon.com> ++# ++# $Id: Makefile 389 2007-06-11 08:29:56Z pablo.martin $ ++# ++# FIXME: Put this in the main Makefile.am ++# ++all: fonsign dump_key ++ ++fonsign: ++ gcc -g sign_openssl.c -D__MAINTEST__ -o fonsign -lssl ++ ++dump_key: ++ gcc -o dump_key dump_key.c ++ ./dump_key > public_key.h ++ ++foncheckrsa: ++ gcc -g bigint.c fonrsa.c rmd160.c foncheckrsa.c base64.c log.c -o foncheckrsa ++ ++#private_fon_rsa_key.pem: ++# openssl genrsa -out private_fon_rsa_key.pem 4096 ++# openssl rsa -in private_fon_rsa_key.pem -pubout -out public_fon_rsa_key.pem ++ ++clean: ++ rm fonsign dump_key +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/public_key.h +@@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ ++unsigned char public_key[] = { ++ 0x2D,0x2D,0x2D,0x2D,0x2D,0x42,0x45,0x47,0x49,0x4E,0x20,0x50,0x55,0x42,0x4C,0x49, ++ 0x43,0x20,0x4B,0x45,0x59,0x2D,0x2D,0x2D,0x2D,0x2D,0x0A,0x4D,0x49,0x49,0x43,0x49, ++ 0x6A,0x41,0x4E,0x42,0x67,0x6B,0x71,0x68,0x6B,0x69,0x47,0x39,0x77,0x30,0x42,0x41, ++ 0x51,0x45,0x46,0x41,0x41,0x4F,0x43,0x41,0x67,0x38,0x41,0x4D,0x49,0x49,0x43,0x43, ++ 0x67,0x4B,0x43,0x41,0x67,0x45,0x41,0x34,0x4C,0x42,0x76,0x59,0x43,0x4B,0x38,0x38, ++ 0x6D,0x75,0x57,0x61,0x73,0x31,0x4F,0x53,0x73,0x71,0x30,0x0A,0x38,0x39,0x38,0x79, ++ 0x76,0x54,0x4B,0x71,0x41,0x6E,0x4F,0x37,0x78,0x2F,0x44,0x53,0x57,0x72,0x46,0x53, ++ 0x30,0x42,0x72,0x47,0x53,0x51,0x31,0x52,0x69,0x44,0x39,0x55,0x62,0x78,0x77,0x6F, ++ 0x64,0x76,0x36,0x65,0x51,0x4B,0x55,0x30,0x67,0x36,0x52,0x6B,0x2F,0x39,0x54,0x70, ++ 0x4C,0x6E,0x4F,0x2F,0x76,0x51,0x4B,0x70,0x69,0x41,0x30,0x30,0x0A,0x2B,0x32,0x59, ++ 0x30,0x74,0x6B,0x4C,0x39,0x73,0x6A,0x37,0x64,0x33,0x57,0x4B,0x47,0x39,0x62,0x6A, ++ 0x64,0x51,0x58,0x2F,0x43,0x49,0x35,0x57,0x46,0x42,0x42,0x64,0x77,0x57,0x73,0x74, ++ 0x4D,0x43,0x38,0x77,0x74,0x4C,0x6A,0x6A,0x45,0x59,0x79,0x43,0x58,0x46,0x32,0x31, ++ 0x30,0x39,0x7A,0x31,0x47,0x54,0x4C,0x73,0x53,0x44,0x34,0x57,0x4F,0x0A,0x45,0x50, ++ 0x6D,0x45,0x37,0x34,0x63,0x6E,0x6F,0x35,0x78,0x53,0x43,0x71,0x71,0x33,0x74,0x54, ++ 0x49,0x6D,0x38,0x50,0x78,0x49,0x77,0x54,0x46,0x6D,0x46,0x6F,0x6D,0x6A,0x76,0x31, ++ 0x4F,0x56,0x50,0x32,0x73,0x42,0x49,0x70,0x35,0x4E,0x2B,0x59,0x6F,0x56,0x61,0x53, ++ 0x58,0x6A,0x47,0x66,0x4E,0x63,0x54,0x36,0x4E,0x6B,0x39,0x76,0x6B,0x56,0x0A,0x57, ++ 0x69,0x67,0x39,0x30,0x71,0x50,0x4E,0x4C,0x58,0x6E,0x39,0x39,0x50,0x78,0x48,0x61, ++ 0x49,0x31,0x36,0x52,0x7A,0x78,0x48,0x4C,0x39,0x54,0x42,0x2B,0x50,0x43,0x33,0x68, ++ 0x33,0x61,0x58,0x33,0x71,0x57,0x30,0x4B,0x4C,0x4A,0x41,0x66,0x6F,0x35,0x70,0x48, ++ 0x6C,0x39,0x79,0x75,0x55,0x70,0x37,0x66,0x46,0x65,0x6A,0x4A,0x2B,0x41,0x58,0x0A, ++ 0x51,0x4F,0x4A,0x62,0x53,0x45,0x67,0x56,0x74,0x76,0x72,0x68,0x44,0x39,0x73,0x55, ++ 0x6D,0x4B,0x30,0x74,0x36,0x63,0x51,0x44,0x65,0x32,0x32,0x4E,0x4E,0x6E,0x77,0x37, ++ 0x43,0x4F,0x4F,0x61,0x59,0x49,0x57,0x55,0x55,0x6A,0x79,0x6A,0x68,0x35,0x50,0x4B, ++ 0x64,0x64,0x45,0x4B,0x5A,0x38,0x68,0x62,0x62,0x47,0x65,0x61,0x5A,0x4A,0x6F,0x76, ++ 0x0A,0x63,0x6F,0x51,0x64,0x55,0x56,0x51,0x6D,0x71,0x44,0x53,0x2B,0x6B,0x63,0x2F, ++ 0x41,0x51,0x6C,0x65,0x55,0x36,0x68,0x51,0x6A,0x63,0x55,0x4C,0x57,0x44,0x6B,0x4E, ++ 0x2F,0x6F,0x4F,0x6C,0x33,0x43,0x53,0x65,0x70,0x67,0x54,0x37,0x6B,0x67,0x73,0x52, ++ 0x63,0x63,0x47,0x74,0x66,0x4B,0x65,0x37,0x77,0x4D,0x70,0x35,0x66,0x59,0x4A,0x2B, ++ 0x41,0x0A,0x43,0x46,0x44,0x41,0x6F,0x4C,0x6E,0x58,0x4E,0x6A,0x4E,0x56,0x6C,0x65, ++ 0x73,0x43,0x6B,0x78,0x74,0x6A,0x62,0x4C,0x62,0x49,0x72,0x66,0x32,0x6E,0x43,0x62, ++ 0x32,0x61,0x4D,0x65,0x64,0x31,0x5A,0x48,0x4E,0x4A,0x51,0x75,0x6F,0x4E,0x58,0x67, ++ 0x72,0x43,0x41,0x44,0x31,0x71,0x2B,0x58,0x6E,0x66,0x77,0x63,0x69,0x6D,0x57,0x50, ++ 0x64,0x51,0x0A,0x44,0x59,0x6A,0x6D,0x65,0x44,0x70,0x35,0x77,0x36,0x41,0x4A,0x33, ++ 0x2F,0x35,0x59,0x39,0x55,0x74,0x78,0x47,0x34,0x72,0x51,0x72,0x61,0x68,0x78,0x53, ++ 0x42,0x77,0x43,0x4B,0x57,0x39,0x4B,0x79,0x53,0x31,0x71,0x53,0x76,0x73,0x37,0x7A, ++ 0x59,0x2F,0x52,0x59,0x37,0x4A,0x66,0x36,0x63,0x56,0x6B,0x54,0x43,0x78,0x69,0x33, ++ 0x7A,0x32,0x53,0x0A,0x50,0x46,0x33,0x51,0x64,0x6B,0x30,0x50,0x44,0x2F,0x73,0x2B, ++ 0x6B,0x77,0x39,0x71,0x4F,0x4E,0x79,0x69,0x33,0x67,0x6E,0x61,0x42,0x46,0x6E,0x54, ++ 0x77,0x48,0x7A,0x59,0x69,0x77,0x34,0x2F,0x77,0x6A,0x46,0x33,0x64,0x47,0x68,0x47, ++ 0x4E,0x6B,0x78,0x36,0x70,0x63,0x4E,0x4F,0x52,0x55,0x46,0x4E,0x65,0x4F,0x7A,0x59, ++ 0x76,0x39,0x6F,0x6A,0x0A,0x51,0x59,0x70,0x73,0x55,0x31,0x33,0x6A,0x6D,0x30,0x33, ++ 0x42,0x6F,0x45,0x2B,0x42,0x31,0x64,0x38,0x50,0x47,0x75,0x57,0x2B,0x49,0x7A,0x2F, ++ 0x41,0x4F,0x44,0x7A,0x6B,0x6F,0x56,0x6B,0x39,0x2B,0x57,0x79,0x49,0x33,0x37,0x50, ++ 0x30,0x53,0x7A,0x47,0x4B,0x72,0x2B,0x53,0x33,0x72,0x72,0x74,0x61,0x50,0x6C,0x41, ++ 0x70,0x71,0x4B,0x48,0x55,0x0A,0x6E,0x64,0x35,0x6C,0x30,0x63,0x76,0x75,0x59,0x66, ++ 0x31,0x4C,0x37,0x45,0x52,0x75,0x49,0x58,0x64,0x47,0x4C,0x6A,0x30,0x43,0x41,0x77, ++ 0x45,0x41,0x41,0x51,0x3D,0x3D,0x0A,0x2D,0x2D,0x2D,0x2D,0x2D,0x45,0x4E,0x44,0x20, ++ 0x50,0x55,0x42,0x4C,0x49,0x43,0x20,0x4B,0x45,0x59,0x2D,0x2D,0x2D,0x2D,0x2D,0x0A, ++ }; +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/rmd160.c +@@ -0,0 +1,292 @@ ++/********************************************************************\ ++ * ++ * FILE: rmd160.c ++ * ++ * CONTENTS: A sample C-implementation of the RIPEMD-160 ++ * hash-function. ++ * TARGET: any computer with an ANSI C compiler ++ * ++ * AUTHOR: Antoon Bosselaers, ESAT-COSIC ++ * DATE: 1 March 1996 ++ * VERSION: 1.0 ++ * ++ * Copyright (c) Katholieke Universiteit Leuven ++ * 1996, All Rights Reserved ++ * ++ * Conditions for use of the RIPEMD-160 Software ++ * ++ * The RIPEMD-160 software is freely available for use under the terms and ++ * conditions described hereunder, which shall be deemed to be accepted by ++ * any user of the software and applicable on any use of the software: ++ * ++ * 1. K.U.Leuven Department of Electrical Engineering-ESAT/COSIC shall for ++ * all purposes be considered the owner of the RIPEMD-160 software and of ++ * all copyright, trade secret, patent or other intellectual property ++ * rights therein. ++ * 2. The RIPEMD-160 software is provided on an "as is" basis without ++ * warranty of any sort, express or implied. K.U.Leuven makes no ++ * representation that the use of the software will not infringe any ++ * patent or proprietary right of third parties. User will indemnify ++ * K.U.Leuven and hold K.U.Leuven harmless from any claims or liabilities ++ * which may arise as a result of its use of the software. In no ++ * circumstances K.U.Leuven R&D will be held liable for any deficiency, ++ * fault or other mishappening with regard to the use or performance of ++ * the software. ++ * 3. User agrees to give due credit to K.U.Leuven in scientific publications ++ * or communications in relation with the use of the RIPEMD-160 software ++ * as follows: RIPEMD-160 software written by Antoon Bosselaers, ++ * available at http://www.esat.kuleuven.be/~cosicart/ps/AB-9601/. ++ * ++\********************************************************************/ ++ ++/* header files */ ++#include <common.h> ++#include "rmd160.h" ++ ++/********************************************************************/ ++ ++void MDinit(dword *MDbuf) ++{ ++ MDbuf[0] = 0x67452301UL; ++ MDbuf[1] = 0xefcdab89UL; ++ MDbuf[2] = 0x98badcfeUL; ++ MDbuf[3] = 0x10325476UL; ++ MDbuf[4] = 0xc3d2e1f0UL; ++ ++ return; ++} ++ ++/********************************************************************/ ++ ++void compress(dword *MDbuf, dword *X) ++{ ++ dword aa = MDbuf[0], bb = MDbuf[1], cc = MDbuf[2], ++ dd = MDbuf[3], ee = MDbuf[4]; ++ dword aaa = MDbuf[0], bbb = MDbuf[1], ccc = MDbuf[2], ++ ddd = MDbuf[3], eee = MDbuf[4]; ++ ++ /* round 1 */ ++ FF(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[ 0], 11); ++ FF(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[ 1], 14); ++ FF(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[ 2], 15); ++ FF(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[ 3], 12); ++ FF(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[ 4], 5); ++ FF(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[ 5], 8); ++ FF(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[ 6], 7); ++ FF(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[ 7], 9); ++ FF(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[ 8], 11); ++ FF(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[ 9], 13); ++ FF(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[10], 14); ++ FF(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[11], 15); ++ FF(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[12], 6); ++ FF(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[13], 7); ++ FF(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[14], 9); ++ FF(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[15], 8); ++ ++ /* round 2 */ ++ GG(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[ 7], 7); ++ GG(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[ 4], 6); ++ GG(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[13], 8); ++ GG(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[ 1], 13); ++ GG(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[10], 11); ++ GG(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[ 6], 9); ++ GG(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[15], 7); ++ GG(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[ 3], 15); ++ GG(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[12], 7); ++ GG(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[ 0], 12); ++ GG(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[ 9], 15); ++ GG(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[ 5], 9); ++ GG(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[ 2], 11); ++ GG(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[14], 7); ++ GG(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[11], 13); ++ GG(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[ 8], 12); ++ ++ /* round 3 */ ++ HH(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[ 3], 11); ++ HH(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[10], 13); ++ HH(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[14], 6); ++ HH(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[ 4], 7); ++ HH(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[ 9], 14); ++ HH(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[15], 9); ++ HH(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[ 8], 13); ++ HH(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[ 1], 15); ++ HH(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[ 2], 14); ++ HH(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[ 7], 8); ++ HH(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[ 0], 13); ++ HH(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[ 6], 6); ++ HH(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[13], 5); ++ HH(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[11], 12); ++ HH(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[ 5], 7); ++ HH(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[12], 5); ++ ++ /* round 4 */ ++ II(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[ 1], 11); ++ II(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[ 9], 12); ++ II(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[11], 14); ++ II(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[10], 15); ++ II(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[ 0], 14); ++ II(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[ 8], 15); ++ II(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[12], 9); ++ II(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[ 4], 8); ++ II(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[13], 9); ++ II(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[ 3], 14); ++ II(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[ 7], 5); ++ II(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[15], 6); ++ II(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[14], 8); ++ II(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[ 5], 6); ++ II(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[ 6], 5); ++ II(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[ 2], 12); ++ ++ /* round 5 */ ++ JJ(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[ 4], 9); ++ JJ(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[ 0], 15); ++ JJ(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[ 5], 5); ++ JJ(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[ 9], 11); ++ JJ(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[ 7], 6); ++ JJ(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[12], 8); ++ JJ(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[ 2], 13); ++ JJ(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[10], 12); ++ JJ(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[14], 5); ++ JJ(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[ 1], 12); ++ JJ(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[ 3], 13); ++ JJ(aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, X[ 8], 14); ++ JJ(ee, aa, bb, cc, dd, X[11], 11); ++ JJ(dd, ee, aa, bb, cc, X[ 6], 8); ++ JJ(cc, dd, ee, aa, bb, X[15], 5); ++ JJ(bb, cc, dd, ee, aa, X[13], 6); ++ ++ /* parallel round 1 */ ++ JJJ(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[ 5], 8); ++ JJJ(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[14], 9); ++ JJJ(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[ 7], 9); ++ JJJ(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[ 0], 11); ++ JJJ(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[ 9], 13); ++ JJJ(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[ 2], 15); ++ JJJ(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[11], 15); ++ JJJ(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[ 4], 5); ++ JJJ(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[13], 7); ++ JJJ(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[ 6], 7); ++ JJJ(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[15], 8); ++ JJJ(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[ 8], 11); ++ JJJ(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[ 1], 14); ++ JJJ(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[10], 14); ++ JJJ(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[ 3], 12); ++ JJJ(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[12], 6); ++ ++ /* parallel round 2 */ ++ III(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[ 6], 9); ++ III(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[11], 13); ++ III(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[ 3], 15); ++ III(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[ 7], 7); ++ III(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[ 0], 12); ++ III(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[13], 8); ++ III(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[ 5], 9); ++ III(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[10], 11); ++ III(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[14], 7); ++ III(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[15], 7); ++ III(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[ 8], 12); ++ III(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[12], 7); ++ III(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[ 4], 6); ++ III(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[ 9], 15); ++ III(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[ 1], 13); ++ III(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[ 2], 11); ++ ++ /* parallel round 3 */ ++ HHH(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[15], 9); ++ HHH(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[ 5], 7); ++ HHH(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[ 1], 15); ++ HHH(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[ 3], 11); ++ HHH(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[ 7], 8); ++ HHH(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[14], 6); ++ HHH(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[ 6], 6); ++ HHH(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[ 9], 14); ++ HHH(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[11], 12); ++ HHH(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[ 8], 13); ++ HHH(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[12], 5); ++ HHH(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[ 2], 14); ++ HHH(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[10], 13); ++ HHH(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[ 0], 13); ++ HHH(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[ 4], 7); ++ HHH(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[13], 5); ++ ++ /* parallel round 4 */ ++ GGG(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[ 8], 15); ++ GGG(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[ 6], 5); ++ GGG(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[ 4], 8); ++ GGG(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[ 1], 11); ++ GGG(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[ 3], 14); ++ GGG(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[11], 14); ++ GGG(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[15], 6); ++ GGG(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[ 0], 14); ++ GGG(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[ 5], 6); ++ GGG(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[12], 9); ++ GGG(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[ 2], 12); ++ GGG(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[13], 9); ++ GGG(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[ 9], 12); ++ GGG(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[ 7], 5); ++ GGG(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[10], 15); ++ GGG(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[14], 8); ++ ++ /* parallel round 5 */ ++ FFF(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[12] , 8); ++ FFF(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[15] , 5); ++ FFF(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[10] , 12); ++ FFF(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[ 4] , 9); ++ FFF(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[ 1] , 12); ++ FFF(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[ 5] , 5); ++ FFF(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[ 8] , 14); ++ FFF(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[ 7] , 6); ++ FFF(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[ 6] , 8); ++ FFF(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[ 2] , 13); ++ FFF(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[13] , 6); ++ FFF(aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, X[14] , 5); ++ FFF(eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, ddd, X[ 0] , 15); ++ FFF(ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, ccc, X[ 3] , 13); ++ FFF(ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, bbb, X[ 9] , 11); ++ FFF(bbb, ccc, ddd, eee, aaa, X[11] , 11); ++ ++ /* combine results */ ++ ddd += cc + MDbuf[1]; /* final result for MDbuf[0] */ ++ MDbuf[1] = MDbuf[2] + dd + eee; ++ MDbuf[2] = MDbuf[3] + ee + aaa; ++ MDbuf[3] = MDbuf[4] + aa + bbb; ++ MDbuf[4] = MDbuf[0] + bb + ccc; ++ MDbuf[0] = ddd; ++ ++ return; ++} ++ ++/********************************************************************/ ++ ++void MDfinish(dword *MDbuf, byte *strptr, dword lswlen, dword mswlen) ++{ ++ unsigned int i; /* counter */ ++ dword X[16]; /* message words */ ++ ++ memset(X, 0, 16*sizeof(dword)); ++ ++ /* put bytes from strptr into X */ ++ for (i=0; i<(lswlen&63); i++) { ++ /* byte i goes into word X[i div 4] at pos. 8*(i mod 4) */ ++ X[i>>2] ^= (dword) *strptr++ << (8 * (i&3)); ++ } ++ ++ /* append the bit m_n == 1 */ ++ X[(lswlen>>2)&15] ^= (dword)1 << (8*(lswlen&3) + 7); ++ ++ if ((lswlen & 63) > 55) { ++ /* length goes to next block */ ++ compress(MDbuf, X); ++ memset(X, 0, 16*sizeof(dword)); ++ } ++ ++ /* append length in bits*/ ++ X[14] = lswlen << 3; ++ X[15] = (lswlen >> 29) | (mswlen << 3); ++ compress(MDbuf, X); ++ ++ return; ++} ++ ++/************************ end of file rmd160.c **********************/ ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/rmd160.h +@@ -0,0 +1,154 @@ ++/********************************************************************\ ++ * ++ * FILE: rmd160.h ++ * ++ * CONTENTS: Header file for a sample C-implementation of the ++ * RIPEMD-160 hash-function. ++ * TARGET: any computer with an ANSI C compiler ++ * ++ * AUTHOR: Antoon Bosselaers, ESAT-COSIC ++ * DATE: 1 March 1996 ++ * VERSION: 1.0 ++ * ++ * Copyright (c) Katholieke Universiteit Leuven ++ * 1996, All Rights Reserved ++ * ++ * Conditions for use of the RIPEMD-160 Software ++ * ++ * The RIPEMD-160 software is freely available for use under the terms and ++ * conditions described hereunder, which shall be deemed to be accepted by ++ * any user of the software and applicable on any use of the software: ++ * ++ * 1. K.U.Leuven Department of Electrical Engineering-ESAT/COSIC shall for ++ * all purposes be considered the owner of the RIPEMD-160 software and of ++ * all copyright, trade secret, patent or other intellectual property ++ * rights therein. ++ * 2. The RIPEMD-160 software is provided on an "as is" basis without ++ * warranty of any sort, express or implied. K.U.Leuven makes no ++ * representation that the use of the software will not infringe any ++ * patent or proprietary right of third parties. User will indemnify ++ * K.U.Leuven and hold K.U.Leuven harmless from any claims or liabilities ++ * which may arise as a result of its use of the software. In no ++ * circumstances K.U.Leuven R&D will be held liable for any deficiency, ++ * fault or other mishappening with regard to the use or performance of ++ * the software. ++ * 3. User agrees to give due credit to K.U.Leuven in scientific publications ++ * or communications in relation with the use of the RIPEMD-160 software ++ * as follows: RIPEMD-160 software written by Antoon Bosselaers, ++ * available at http://www.esat.kuleuven.be/~cosicart/ps/AB-9601/. ++ * ++\********************************************************************/ ++ ++#ifndef RMD160H /* make sure this file is read only once */ ++#define RMD160H ++ ++/********************************************************************/ ++ ++/* typedef 8 and 32 bit types, resp. */ ++/* adapt these, if necessary, ++ for your operating system and compiler */ ++typedef unsigned char byte; ++typedef unsigned long dword; ++ ++ ++/********************************************************************/ ++ ++/* macro definitions */ ++ ++/* collect four bytes into one word: */ ++#define BYTES_TO_DWORD(strptr) \ ++ (((dword) *((strptr)+3) << 24) | \ ++ ((dword) *((strptr)+2) << 16) | \ ++ ((dword) *((strptr)+1) << 8) | \ ++ ((dword) *(strptr))) ++ ++/* ROL(x, n) cyclically rotates x over n bits to the left */ ++/* x must be of an unsigned 32 bits type and 0 <= n < 32. */ ++#define ROL(x, n) (((x) << (n)) | ((x) >> (32-(n)))) ++ ++/* the five basic functions F(), G() and H() */ ++#define F(x, y, z) ((x) ^ (y) ^ (z)) ++#define G(x, y, z) (((x) & (y)) | (~(x) & (z))) ++#define H(x, y, z) (((x) | ~(y)) ^ (z)) ++#define I(x, y, z) (((x) & (z)) | ((y) & ~(z))) ++#define J(x, y, z) ((x) ^ ((y) | ~(z))) ++ ++/* the ten basic operations FF() through III() */ ++#define FF(a, b, c, d, e, x, s) {\ ++ (a) += F((b), (c), (d)) + (x);\ ++ (a) = ROL((a), (s)) + (e);\ ++ (c) = ROL((c), 10);\ ++ } ++#define GG(a, b, c, d, e, x, s) {\ ++ (a) += G((b), (c), (d)) + (x) + 0x5a827999UL;\ ++ (a) = ROL((a), (s)) + (e);\ ++ (c) = ROL((c), 10);\ ++ } ++#define HH(a, b, c, d, e, x, s) {\ ++ (a) += H((b), (c), (d)) + (x) + 0x6ed9eba1UL;\ ++ (a) = ROL((a), (s)) + (e);\ ++ (c) = ROL((c), 10);\ ++ } ++#define II(a, b, c, d, e, x, s) {\ ++ (a) += I((b), (c), (d)) + (x) + 0x8f1bbcdcUL;\ ++ (a) = ROL((a), (s)) + (e);\ ++ (c) = ROL((c), 10);\ ++ } ++#define JJ(a, b, c, d, e, x, s) {\ ++ (a) += J((b), (c), (d)) + (x) + 0xa953fd4eUL;\ ++ (a) = ROL((a), (s)) + (e);\ ++ (c) = ROL((c), 10);\ ++ } ++#define FFF(a, b, c, d, e, x, s) {\ ++ (a) += F((b), (c), (d)) + (x);\ ++ (a) = ROL((a), (s)) + (e);\ ++ (c) = ROL((c), 10);\ ++ } ++#define GGG(a, b, c, d, e, x, s) {\ ++ (a) += G((b), (c), (d)) + (x) + 0x7a6d76e9UL;\ ++ (a) = ROL((a), (s)) + (e);\ ++ (c) = ROL((c), 10);\ ++ } ++#define HHH(a, b, c, d, e, x, s) {\ ++ (a) += H((b), (c), (d)) + (x) + 0x6d703ef3UL;\ ++ (a) = ROL((a), (s)) + (e);\ ++ (c) = ROL((c), 10);\ ++ } ++#define III(a, b, c, d, e, x, s) {\ ++ (a) += I((b), (c), (d)) + (x) + 0x5c4dd124UL;\ ++ (a) = ROL((a), (s)) + (e);\ ++ (c) = ROL((c), 10);\ ++ } ++#define JJJ(a, b, c, d, e, x, s) {\ ++ (a) += J((b), (c), (d)) + (x) + 0x50a28be6UL;\ ++ (a) = ROL((a), (s)) + (e);\ ++ (c) = ROL((c), 10);\ ++ } ++ ++/********************************************************************/ ++ ++/* function prototypes */ ++ ++void MDinit(dword *MDbuf); ++/* ++ * initializes MDbuffer to "magic constants" ++ */ ++ ++void compress(dword *MDbuf, dword *X); ++/* ++ * the compression function. ++ * transforms MDbuf using message bytes X[0] through X[15] ++ */ ++ ++void MDfinish(dword *MDbuf, byte *strptr, dword lswlen, dword mswlen); ++/* ++ * puts bytes from strptr into X and pad out; appends length ++ * and finally, compresses the last block(s) ++ * note: length in bits == 8 * (lswlen + 2^32 mswlen). ++ * note: there are (lswlen mod 64) bytes left in strptr. ++ */ ++ ++#endif /* RMD160H */ ++ ++/*********************** end of file rmd160.h ***********************/ ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/rsa.c +@@ -0,0 +1,303 @@ ++/* ++ * FONSM RSA handling library ++ * ++ * This file is part of FONUCS. Copyright (C) 2007 FON Wireless Ltd. ++ * ++ * This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify ++ * it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by ++ * the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or ++ * (at your option) any later version. ++ * ++ * This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, ++ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of ++ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the ++ * GNU Lesser General Public License for more details. ++ * ++ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License ++ * along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software ++ * Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA ++ * ++ * Created: 20070306 Pablo Martin Medrano <pablo@fon.com> ++ * ++ * Based on axTLS ++ * ++ * $Id: fonrsa.c 405 2007-09-19 15:26:17Z jesus.pico $ ++ */ ++#include <malloc.h> ++#include <common.h> ++#include "rsa.h" ++#include "rmd160.h" ++#include "bigint.h" ++#include "base64.h" ++ ++#include "public_key.h" ++ ++#define RMDsize 160 /* A RIPEMD-160 hash has 160 bits */ ++ ++typedef struct { ++ uint8_t *buffer; ++ size_t size; ++} DER_key; ++ ++typedef struct { ++ bigint *m; /* modulus */ ++ bigint *e; /* public exponent */ ++ int num_octets; ++ BI_CTX *bi_ctx; /* big integer handle */ ++} RSA_parameters; ++ ++typedef struct { ++ DER_key *derkey; ++ RSA_parameters *rsaparms; ++} RSA; ++ ++static void CH_free_der_key(DER_key *key) ++{ ++ free(key->buffer); ++ free(key); ++} ++ ++int CH_decrypt(RSA_parameters *rsa, uint8_t *buffer_in, uint8_t *buffer_out) ++{ ++ bigint *dat_bi; ++ bigint *decrypted_bi; ++ int byte_size; ++ ++ byte_size = rsa->num_octets; ++ dat_bi = bi_import(rsa->bi_ctx, buffer_in, byte_size); ++ rsa->bi_ctx->mod_offset = BIGINT_M_OFFSET; ++ bi_copy(rsa->m); ++ decrypted_bi = bi_mod_power(rsa->bi_ctx, dat_bi, rsa->e); ++ bi_export(rsa->bi_ctx, decrypted_bi, buffer_out, byte_size); ++ return 0; ++} ++ ++byte *RMDbinary(char *buffer, int len) ++{ ++ byte data[1024]; /* contains current mess. block */ ++ dword nbytes; /* length of this block */ ++ dword MDbuf[RMDsize / 32]; /* contains (A, B, C, D(, E)) */ ++ static byte hashcode[RMDsize / 8]; /* for final hash-value */ ++ dword X[16]; /* current 16-word chunk */ ++ unsigned int i, j; /* counters */ ++ dword length[2]; /* length in bytes of message */ ++ dword offset; /* # of unprocessed bytes at */ ++ /* call of MDfinish */ ++ int total = len; ++ char *tmp = buffer; ++ MDinit(MDbuf); ++ length[0] = 0; ++ length[1] = 0; ++ while ( len) { ++ memcpy(data, tmp, 1024); ++ if(len > 1024) ++ { ++ nbytes = 1024; ++ len -= 1024; ++ tmp += 1024; ++ } else { ++ nbytes = len; ++ len = 0; ++ } ++ /* process all complete blocks */ ++ for (i = 0; i < (nbytes >> 6); i++) { ++ for (j = 0; j < 16; j++) ++ X[j] = BYTES_TO_DWORD(data + 64 * i + 4 * j); ++ compress(MDbuf, X); ++ } ++ /* update length[] */ ++ if (length[0] + nbytes < length[0]) ++ length[1]++; /* overflow to msb of length */ ++ length[0] += nbytes; ++ } ++ /* finish: */ ++ offset = length[0] & 0x3C0; /* extract bytes 6 to 10 inclusive */ ++ MDfinish(MDbuf, data + offset, length[0], length[1]); ++ ++ for (i = 0; i < RMDsize / 8; i += 4) { ++ hashcode[i] = MDbuf[i >> 2]; ++ hashcode[i + 1] = (MDbuf[i >> 2] >> 8); ++ hashcode[i + 2] = (MDbuf[i >> 2] >> 16); ++ hashcode[i + 3] = (MDbuf[i >> 2] >> 24); ++ } ++ ++ return (byte *) hashcode; ++} ++ ++static DER_key *CH_load_pem_key(void) ++{ ++ DER_key *ret; ++ uint8_t *buffer; ++ char *b64,*p,*t; ++ char key[1024]; ++ size_t filesize; ++ int size; ++ ++ if ((ret = (DER_key *)malloc(sizeof(DER_key))) == NULL) ++ return NULL; ++ buffer = public_key; ++ p = (char *)buffer; ++ while ((*p != '\n') && (*p != '\0')) ++ p++; ++ if (*p == '\0') { ++ free(ret); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ p++; ++ b64 = t = p; ++ while((p - b64) <= filesize) { ++ if ((*p == '-')) { ++ break; ++ } else if ((*p != '\n') && (*p != ' ') && (*p != '\t')) { ++ *t = *p; ++ t++; ++ } ++ p++; ++ } ++ *t = '\0'; ++ size = B64_decode(b64, key, strlen(b64), 1024); ++ if (size < 0) { ++ free(buffer); ++ free(ret); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ //free(buffer); ++ ret->buffer = (char *)malloc(size); ++ ret->size = size; ++ memcpy((void *)ret->buffer, (void *)key, size); ++ return ret; ++} ++ ++/* ++ * Similar to RSA_pub_key_new, rewritten to make this program depend only on bi module ++ */ ++void CH_pub_key_new(RSA_parameters **rsa, const uint8_t *modulus, int mod_len, const uint8_t *pub_exp, int pub_len) ++{ ++ RSA_parameters *rsa_parameters; ++ ++ BI_CTX *bi_ctx = bi_initialize(); ++ *rsa = (RSA_parameters *)calloc(1, sizeof(RSA_parameters)); ++ rsa_parameters = *rsa; ++ rsa_parameters->bi_ctx = bi_ctx; ++ rsa_parameters->num_octets = (mod_len & 0xFFF0); ++ rsa_parameters->m = bi_import(bi_ctx, modulus, mod_len); ++ bi_set_mod(bi_ctx, rsa_parameters->m, BIGINT_M_OFFSET); ++ rsa_parameters->e = bi_import(bi_ctx, pub_exp, pub_len); ++ bi_permanent(rsa_parameters->e); ++} ++ ++/* ++ * Get the public key specifics from an ASN.1 encoded file ++ * A function lacking in the exported axTLS API ++ * ++ * This is a really weird hack that only works with RSA public key ++ * files ++ */ ++static int asn1_get_public_key(const uint8_t *buf, int len, RSA_parameters **rsa_parameters) ++{ ++ uint8_t *modulus, *pub_exp; ++ int mod_len, pub_len; ++ ++ pub_len = 3; ++ mod_len = len - 37; ++ if (buf[0] != 0x30) { ++ return -1; ++ } ++ ++ pub_exp = (uint8_t *)malloc(3); ++ modulus = (uint8_t *)malloc(mod_len); ++ memcpy(modulus, buf + 32 , mod_len); ++ memcpy(pub_exp, buf + 34 + mod_len, 3); ++ if (mod_len <= 0 || pub_len <= 0 ) ++ return -1; ++ CH_pub_key_new(rsa_parameters, modulus, mod_len, pub_exp, pub_len); ++ ++ free(modulus); ++ free(pub_exp); ++ return 0; ++} ++ ++ ++/* FR_init */ ++void *FR_init(void) ++{ ++ DER_key *derkey; ++ RSA_parameters *rsa_parameters; ++ ++ derkey = CH_load_pem_key(); ++ if ((asn1_get_public_key(derkey->buffer, derkey->size, &rsa_parameters)) != 0) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error: Extracting public key from file\n"); ++ return 0; ++ } ++ CH_free_der_key(derkey); ++ return (void *)rsa_parameters; ++} ++ ++FONRSA_ERROR FR_end(void *handle) ++{ ++ RSA_parameters *rsa_parameters = (RSA_parameters *)handle; ++ ++ free(rsa_parameters); ++ return FONRSA_OK; ++} ++ ++/* ++ * ++ * Implementation of PKCS 1.5 padding, borrowed from ++ * Tom's code (public domain) ++ */ ++ ++/* Standalone FR_verify_file */ ++FONRSA_ERROR FR_verify_file(void *handler, char *file_data, int file_len, ++ char *signature_buffer, int signature_size) ++{ ++ int j; ++ byte *hashcode; ++ byte hash[20]; ++ uint8_t *decrypted; ++ RSA_parameters *rsa_parameters = (RSA_parameters *)handler; ++ ++ /* Calculates the RIPEMD-160 hash of the file */ ++ hashcode = RMDbinary (file_data, file_len); ++ ++ if (rsa_parameters->num_octets != signature_size) ++ return FONRSA_SIZE; ++ decrypted = (uint8_t *)malloc(rsa_parameters->num_octets); ++ if (CH_decrypt(rsa_parameters, signature_buffer, decrypted)) { ++ printf("Error: Decrypting signature\n"); ++ return FONRSA_VERIFICATION_FAILURE; ++ } ++ memcpy(hash, decrypted + 492, 20); ++ //free(decrypted); ++ //free(signature_buffer); ++ for (j = 0; j < RMDsize/8; j++) { ++ if (hash[j] != hashcode[j]) ++ return FONRSA_VERIFICATION_FAILURE; ++ } ++ return FONRSA_OK; ++} ++ ++int rsa_check_signature(char *signature, int signature_len, char *buffer, int buffer_len) ++{ ++ FONRSA_ERROR fonrsa_error; ++ void *handle; ++ handle = FR_init(); ++ if (handle == NULL) { ++ printf("Error loading keys\n"); ++ return 1; ++ } ++ fonrsa_error = FR_verify_file(handle, buffer, buffer_len, signature, signature_len); ++ FR_end(handle); ++ switch (fonrsa_error) { ++ case FONRSA_OK: ++ printf("Verified OK\n"); ++ return 0; ++ case FONRSA_VERIFICATION_FAILURE: ++ printf("Verification failure\n"); ++ return 1; ++ default: ++ printf("Verification error\n"); ++ return -1; ++ } ++ ++} +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/rsa.h +@@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ ++/* ++ * FONSM RSA handling library, used by fonsmcd and foncheckrsa ++ * ++ * This file is part of FONUCS. Copyright (C) 2007 FON Wireless Ltd. ++ * ++ * This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify ++ * it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by ++ * the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or ++ * (at your option) any later version. ++ * ++ * This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, ++ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of ++ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the ++ * GNU Lesser General Public License for more details. ++ * ++ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License ++ * along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software ++ * Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA ++ * ++ * Created: 20070306 Pablo Martin Medrano <pablo@fon.com> ++ * ++ * $Id: fonrsa.h 404 2007-09-17 10:41:31Z jesus.pico $ ++ */ ++#ifndef _FONRSA_H ++#define _FONRSA_H ++ ++#define MINIMUM_PADING_BYTES_PKCS_1_5 3 ++ ++typedef enum { ++ FONRSA_OK = 0, ++ FONRSA_VERIFICATION_FAILURE = 1, ++ FONRSA_OPENKEY = 2, ++ FONRSA_SIZE = 3, ++ FONRSA_LOADFILE = 4, ++ FONRSA_CRYPT = 5, ++ FONRSA_DECRYPT = 6, ++ FONRSA_SAVEFILE = 7, ++ FONRSA_NOSYS = 8, ++ FONRSA_VERIFY = 9 ++} FONRSA_ERROR; ++ ++int rsa_check_signature(char *signature, int signature_len, char *buffer, int buffer_len); ++ ++#endif ++ ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/sign.h +@@ -0,0 +1,27 @@ ++/* ++ * Signature interface ++ * ++ * This file is part of FONUCS. Copyright (C) 2007 FON Wireless Ltd. ++ * ++ * Created: 20070417 Pablo MartÃn Medrano <pablo@fon.com> ++ * ++ * $Id: sign.h 389 2007-06-11 08:29:56Z pablo.martin $ ++ */ ++#ifndef __SIGN_H__ ++#define __SIGN_H__ ++#ifdef __cplusplus ++ extern "C" { ++#endif ++ ++void SG_init(void); ++void *SG_start(char *private_key_path, char *public_key_path); ++void SG_stop(void *handle); ++int SG_crypt(void *data, unsigned char *text, int size_text, unsigned char *crypted_text, ++ unsigned int crypted_text_buffer_size, int *crypted_size); ++int SG_crypt_v2(void *data, unsigned char *text, int size_text, unsigned char *crypted_text, ++ unsigned int crypted_text_buffer_size, int *crypted_size); ++#ifdef __cplusplus ++} ++#endif ++#endif /* #ifdef __SIGN_H__ */ ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/rsa/sign_openssl.c +@@ -0,0 +1,437 @@ ++/* ++ * Signature using OpenSSL ++ * ++ * This file is part of FONUCS. Copyright (C) 2007 FON Wireless Ltd. ++ * ++ * Created: 20070417 Pablo MartÃn Medrano <pablo@fon.com> ++ * ++ * $Id: sign_openssl.c 346 2007-05-10 19:51:38Z pablo.martin $ ++ */ ++/* ++ * ++ * How the RSA public and private key was generated ++ * To check .FON files ++ * openssl genrsa -out private_fon_rsa_key.pem 4096 ++ * openssl rsa -in private_fon_rsa_key.pem -pubout -out public_fon_rsa_key.pem ++ * ++ * How the Status Manager public and private key was generated ++ * openssl genrsa -out private_sm_rsa_key.pem 2048 ++ * openssl rsa -in private_sm_rsa_key.pem -pubout -out public_sm_rsa_key.pem ++ * ++ * How to sign using the RSA private key (This is what fonsign does) ++ * openssl dgst -rmd160 -sign private_fon_rsa_key.pem FILE > SIGNATURE ++ * How to verify using the RSA public key (This is what fonverify + foncheckrsa does) ++ * openssl dgst -rmd160 -verify public_fon_rsa_key.pem -signature SIGNATURE FILE ++ * Convert to DER file (to use it in La Fonera) ++ * openssl rsa -inform PEM -outform DER -pubin -in public_fon_rsa_key.pem -pubout -out public_fon_rsa_key.der ++ */ ++#include <openssl/rsa.h> ++#include <openssl/ssl.h> ++#include <openssl/bn.h> ++#include <openssl/pem.h> ++#include <openssl/evp.h> ++#include <sys/stat.h> ++#include <fcntl.h> ++#ifndef __MAINTEST__ ++#include "log.h" ++#else ++#define fon_warning printf ++#define fon_debug printf ++#define fon_critical printf ++#endif ++#include "sign.h" ++ ++typedef struct { ++ RSA *rsa; ++ int rsa_size; ++ EVP_PKEY *pkey; ++ int pkey_size; ++ RSA *public_rsa; ++ int public_rsa_size; ++ EVP_PKEY *public_pkey; ++ int public_pkey_size; ++} Sign; ++ ++typedef enum { ++ KEY_PUBLIC = 0, ++ KEY_PRIVATE ++} KEY_TYPE; ++ ++static EVP_PKEY *SG_load_key(char *key_path, KEY_TYPE type); ++static unsigned char *load_file_in_buffer(char *path, int *size); ++static int save_file_from_buffer(char *path, char *buffer, int size); ++ ++void SG_init(void) ++{ ++ SSL_load_error_strings(); ++ SSL_library_init(); ++ OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms(); ++ OpenSSL_add_all_ciphers(); ++ OpenSSL_add_all_digests(); ++} ++ ++static unsigned char *load_file_in_buffer(char *path, int *size) ++{ ++ char *buffer; ++ struct stat st; ++ int fd; ++ ++ if (stat(path, &st)) ++ return NULL; ++ buffer = (char *)malloc(st.st_size); ++ if (buffer == NULL) ++ return NULL; ++ if ((fd = open(path, O_RDONLY)) == -1) { ++ free(buffer); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ if (read(fd,buffer,st.st_size) != (ssize_t)st.st_size) { ++ free(buffer); ++ close(fd); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ *size = (int)st.st_size; ++ close(fd); ++ return buffer; ++} ++ ++static int save_file_from_buffer(char *path, char *buffer, int size) ++{ ++ int fd; ++ ++ if ((fd = open(path, O_WRONLY | O_CREAT, 0644)) == -1) ++ return -1; ++ if (write(fd, buffer, (size_t)size) != ((ssize_t)size)) { ++ close(fd); ++ return -1; ++ } ++ close(fd); ++ return 0; ++} ++ ++static EVP_PKEY *SG_load_key(char *key_path, KEY_TYPE type) ++{ ++ BIO *key = NULL; ++ EVP_PKEY *pkey; ++ ++ if ((key = BIO_new(BIO_s_file())) == NULL) { ++ //ERR_print_errors(err); ++ fon_warning("%s: Error calling BIO_new()\n", __FUNCTION__); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ if (BIO_read_filename(key, key_path) <= 0) { ++ fon_warning("%s: Error opening %s\n", __FUNCTION__, key_path); ++ // ERR_print_errors(err); ++ BIO_free(key); ++ } ++ if (type == KEY_PUBLIC) { ++ pkey = PEM_read_bio_PUBKEY(key, NULL, NULL, NULL); ++ } else if (type == KEY_PRIVATE) { ++ pkey = PEM_read_bio_PrivateKey(key, NULL, NULL, NULL); ++ } else { ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ ++ if (pkey == NULL) { ++ fon_warning("%s: Error reading %s\n", __FUNCTION__, key_path); ++ BIO_free(key); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ BIO_free(key); ++ return pkey; ++} ++ ++void *SG_start(char *private_key_path, char *public_key_path) ++{ ++ Sign *sign; ++ ++ if ((sign = (Sign *)malloc(sizeof(Sign))) == NULL) ++ return NULL; ++ memset(sign, 0, sizeof(Sign)); ++ if (private_key_path != NULL) { ++ if ((sign->pkey = SG_load_key(private_key_path, KEY_PRIVATE)) == NULL) { ++ fon_warning("%s: Error loading %s", __FUNCTION__, private_key_path); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ } ++ if (public_key_path != NULL) { ++ if ((sign->public_pkey = SG_load_key(public_key_path, KEY_PUBLIC)) == NULL) { ++ fon_warning("%s: Error loading %s", __FUNCTION__, public_key_path); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ } ++ if (sign->pkey != NULL) { ++ sign->pkey_size = EVP_PKEY_size(sign->pkey); ++ if ((sign->rsa = EVP_PKEY_get1_RSA(sign->pkey)) == NULL) { ++ EVP_PKEY_free(sign->pkey); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ } ++ if (sign->public_pkey != NULL) { ++ sign->public_pkey_size = EVP_PKEY_size(sign->public_pkey); ++ if ((sign->public_rsa = EVP_PKEY_get1_RSA(sign->public_pkey)) == NULL) { ++ EVP_PKEY_free(sign->pkey); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ } ++ if (((sign->rsa == NULL) && (private_key_path != NULL)) || ++ ((sign->public_rsa == NULL) && (public_key_path != NULL))) { ++ fon_warning("%s: Error calling EVP_PKEY_get1_RSA()", __FUNCTION__); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ if (sign->rsa != NULL) { ++ sign->rsa_size = RSA_size(sign->rsa); ++ if (RSA_check_key(sign->rsa) != 1) { ++ fon_warning("%s: RSA key failure", __FUNCTION__); ++ return NULL; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ return (void *)sign; ++} ++ ++void SG_stop(void *handle) ++{ ++ Sign *sign = (Sign *)handle; ++ ++ EVP_PKEY_free(sign->pkey); ++ EVP_PKEY_free(sign->public_pkey); ++ if (sign->rsa != NULL) ++ RSA_free(sign->rsa); ++ if (sign->public_rsa != NULL) ++ RSA_free(sign->public_rsa); ++ free(sign); ++} ++ ++int SG_verify(void *data, unsigned char *text, unsigned int size_text, ++ unsigned char *signature, unsigned int size_signature) ++{ ++ EVP_MD_CTX mdctx; ++ EVP_MD *md; ++ EVP_PKEY *pkey; ++ int ret; ++ Sign *sign = (Sign *)data; ++ ++ md = (EVP_MD *)EVP_ripemd160(); ++ if(!EVP_VerifyInit(&mdctx, md)) ++ return 4; ++ if (!EVP_VerifyUpdate(&mdctx, (const void *)text, (unsigned int)size_text)) { ++ return 5; ++ } ++ ret = EVP_VerifyFinal(&mdctx, (const char *)signature, size_signature, sign->public_pkey); ++ EVP_PKEY_free(pkey); ++ EVP_MD_CTX_cleanup(&mdctx); ++ return ret; ++} ++ ++int SG_sign(void *data, void *text, unsigned int size_text, void *signature_buffer, ++ unsigned int size_signature_buffer, unsigned int *size_signature) ++{ ++ unsigned char *digest[EVP_MAX_MD_SIZE]; ++ EVP_MD_CTX mdctx; ++ EVP_MD *md; ++ int ret; ++ Sign *sign = (Sign *)data; ++ ++ if (size_signature_buffer < sign->pkey_size) ++ return 1; ++ ++ md = (EVP_MD *)EVP_ripemd160(); ++ EVP_SignInit(&mdctx, md); ++ if (!EVP_SignUpdate(&mdctx, (const void *)text, (unsigned int)size_text)) { ++ return 2; ++ } ++ if (!EVP_SignFinal(&mdctx, (unsigned char *)signature_buffer, (unsigned int *)size_signature, sign->pkey)) { ++ return 3; ++ } ++ EVP_MD_CTX_cleanup(&mdctx); ++ ++ return 0; ++} ++ ++/* ++ * It's not advised to crypt using RAW ... unless you have crypted the buffer using AES before. ++ */ ++int SG_crypt(void *data, unsigned char *text, int size_text, ++ unsigned char *crypted_text, unsigned int crypted_text_buffer_size, ++ int *crypted_size) ++{ ++ EVP_MD_CTX mdctx; ++ EVP_MD *md; ++ int retsize; ++ Sign *sign = (Sign *)data; ++ ++ if (crypted_text_buffer_size < sign->pkey_size) { ++ fon_critical("%s: size_signature_buffer [%u] < %u", __FUNCTION__, size_text, sign->pkey_size); ++ return 1; ++ } ++ if (size_text != sign->pkey_size) { ++ fon_critical("%s: size_text [%u] != %u", __FUNCTION__, size_text, sign->pkey_size); ++ return 2; ++ } ++ /* The buffer is pre-padded with random data ... */ ++ fon_debug("%s: About to call RSA_private_encrypt(%d, %x, %x, %x, %d)", ++ __FUNCTION__, size_text, crypted_text, sign->rsa, RSA_NO_PADDING); ++ retsize = RSA_private_encrypt(size_text, text, crypted_text, sign->rsa, RSA_NO_PADDING); ++ if (retsize == -1) { ++ fon_critical("%s: Error calling RSA_private_encrypt(%d, %x, %x, %x, %d)", ++ __FUNCTION__, size_text, crypted_text, sign->rsa, RSA_NO_PADDING); ++ return 1; ++ } ++ *crypted_size = retsize; ++ return 0; ++} ++ ++/* SG_decrypt */ ++int SG_decrypt(void *data, unsigned char *cryptext, int cryptext_size, unsigned char *plaintext, ++ int plaintext_buffer_size, int *plaintext_size) ++{ ++ EVP_MD_CTX mdctx; ++ EVP_MD *md; ++ int retsize; ++ Sign *sign = (Sign *)data; ++ ++ if (plaintext_buffer_size < sign->public_pkey_size) { ++ fon_critical("%s: plaintext_buffer_size [%u] < %u", __FUNCTION__, plaintext_buffer_size, sign->public_pkey_size); ++ return 1; ++ } ++ if (cryptext_size != sign->public_pkey_size) { ++ fon_critical("%s: cryptext_size [%u] != %u", __FUNCTION__, cryptext_size, sign->public_pkey_size); ++ return 2; ++ } ++ retsize = RSA_public_decrypt(cryptext_size, cryptext, plaintext, sign->public_rsa, RSA_NO_PADDING); ++ if (retsize == -1) ++ return 1; ++ *plaintext_size = retsize; ++ return 0; ++} ++ ++#ifdef __MAINTEST__ ++int main(int argc, char **argv) ++{ ++ size_t argv0_size; ++ char *token; ++ ++ argv0_size = strlen(argv[0]); ++ if (argv0_size < 7) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "%s?", argv[0]); ++ return 1; ++ } ++ token = argv[0] + argv0_size - 7; ++ ++ SG_init(); ++ if (!strcmp(token, "fonsign")) { ++ return main_fonsign(argc, argv); ++ } else if (!strcmp(token, "foncryp")) { ++ return main_foncryp(argc, argv); ++ } ++ fprintf(stderr, "%s?", argv[0]); ++ return 1; ++} ++ ++int main_foncryp(int argc, char **argv) ++{ ++ void *handle = NULL; ++ int encrypt = 0; ++ char *filebuffer = NULL; ++ char crypted[1024]; ++ int size, crypted_size, ret; ++ ++ if (argc != 5) { ++ printf("Usage: %s encrypt|decrypt <key_file> <file> <crypted_file>\n", argv[0]); ++ return 1; ++ } ++ if (!strcmp(argv[1], "encrypt")) { ++ printf("Encryption mode\n"); ++ encrypt = 1; ++ } else ++ printf("Decryption mode\n"); ++ if (encrypt) ++ handle = SG_start(argv[2], NULL); ++ else ++ handle = SG_start(NULL, argv[2]); ++ if (handle == NULL) { ++ printf("Error loading keys\n"); ++ return 1; ++ } ++ ++ filebuffer = load_file_in_buffer(argv[3], &size); ++ if (filebuffer == NULL) { ++ printf("Error reading %s\n", argv[3]); ++ SG_stop(handle); ++ return 1; ++ } ++ if (encrypt) ++ ret = SG_crypt(handle, filebuffer, size, crypted, 1024, &crypted_size); ++ else ++ ret = SG_decrypt(handle, filebuffer, size, crypted, 1024, &crypted_size); ++ ++ if (ret) { ++ printf("Error crypting %d bytes\n", size); ++ SG_stop(handle); ++ return 1; ++ } ++ printf("Crypted size %d\n", crypted_size); ++ if (save_file_from_buffer(argv[4], crypted, crypted_size)) { ++ printf("Error saving file\n"); ++ SG_stop(handle); ++ return 1; ++ } ++ ++ SG_stop(handle); ++ return 0; ++} ++ ++int main_fonsign(int argc, char **argv) ++{ ++ void *handle = NULL; ++ char signature_buffer[4096]; ++ char *signature; ++ unsigned int signature_size; ++ struct stat st; ++ char *filebuffer = NULL; ++ int size; ++ int ret = -1; ++ ++ if (argc != 5) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "usage: %s <private_key_file> <public_key_file> <file_to_sign> <signature_file>\n", argv[0]); ++ goto end; ++ } ++ handle = SG_start(argv[1], argv[2]); ++ if (handle == NULL) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error calling SG_start(%s)\n", argv[1]); ++ goto end; ++ } ++ filebuffer = load_file_in_buffer(argv[3], &size); ++ if (filebuffer == NULL) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error reading %s\n", argv[3]); ++ goto end; ++ } ++ if (SG_sign(handle, filebuffer, size, signature_buffer, 4096, &signature_size)) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error calling SG_sign()\n"); ++ goto end; ++ } ++ ret = SG_verify(handle, filebuffer, size, signature_buffer, signature_size); ++ if (ret == 0) ++ fprintf(stderr, "signature failure\n"); ++ else if (ret == 1) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "signature ok\n"); ++ ret = 0; ++ } else { ++ fprintf(stderr, "signature error\n"); ++ goto end; ++ } ++ if (save_file_from_buffer(argv[4], signature_buffer, signature_size)) { ++ fprintf(stderr, "Error writing to %s\n", argv[4]); ++ goto end; ++ } ++ ret = 0; ++end: ++ if (filebuffer != NULL) ++ free(filebuffer); ++ if (handle != NULL) ++ SG_stop(handle); ++ return ret; ++} ++#endif ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/fs.c +@@ -0,0 +1,154 @@ ++/** ++ * \addtogroup httpd ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \file ++ * HTTP server read-only file system code. ++ * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> ++ * ++ * A simple read-only filesystem. ++ */ ++ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001, Swedish Institute of Computer Science. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors ++ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software ++ * without specific prior written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND ++ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE ++ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE ++ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS ++ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) ++ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT ++ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY ++ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF ++ * SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * This file is part of the lwIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * ++ * Author: Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> ++ * ++ * $Id: fs.c,v 1.7.2.3 2003/10/07 13:22:27 adam Exp $ ++ */ ++ ++#include "uip.h" ++#include "httpd.h" ++#include "fs.h" ++#include "fsdata.h" ++ ++#include "fsdata.c" ++ ++#ifdef FS_STATISTICS ++#if FS_STATISTICS == 1 ++static u16_t count[FS_NUMFILES]; ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++static u8_t ++fs_strcmp(const char *str1, const char *str2) ++{ ++ u8_t i; ++ i = 0; ++ loop: ++ ++ if(str2[i] == 0 || ++ str1[i] == '\r' || ++ str1[i] == '\n') { ++ return 0; ++ } ++ ++ if(str1[i] != str2[i]) { ++ return 1; ++ } ++ ++ ++ ++i; ++ goto loop; ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++int ++fs_open(const char *name, struct fs_file *file) ++{ ++#ifdef FS_STATISTICS ++#if FS_STATISTICS == 1 ++ u16_t i = 0; ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++ struct fsdata_file_noconst *f; ++ ++ for(f = (struct fsdata_file_noconst *)FS_ROOT; ++ f != NULL; ++ f = (struct fsdata_file_noconst *)f->next) { ++ ++ if(fs_strcmp(name, f->name) == 0) { ++ file->data = f->data; ++ file->len = f->len; ++#ifdef FS_STATISTICS ++#if FS_STATISTICS == 1 ++ ++count[i]; ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++ return 1; ++ } ++#ifdef FS_STATISTICS ++#if FS_STATISTICS == 1 ++ ++i; ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++ ++ } ++ return 0; ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++void ++fs_init(void) ++{ ++#ifdef FS_STATISTICS ++#if FS_STATISTICS == 1 ++ u16_t i; ++ for(i = 0; i < FS_NUMFILES; i++) { ++ count[i] = 0; ++ } ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++#ifdef FS_STATISTICS ++#if FS_STATISTICS == 1 ++u16_t fs_count ++(char *name) ++{ ++ struct fsdata_file_noconst *f; ++ u16_t i; ++ ++ i = 0; ++ for(f = (struct fsdata_file_noconst *)FS_ROOT; ++ f != NULL; ++ f = (struct fsdata_file_noconst *)f->next) { ++ ++ if(fs_strcmp(name, f->name) == 0) { ++ return count[i]; ++ } ++ ++i; ++ } ++ return 0; ++} ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/fsdata.c +@@ -0,0 +1,199 @@ ++static const char data_flashing_html[] = { ++ /* /flashing.html */ ++ 0x2f, 0x66, 0x6c, 0x61, 0x73, 0x68, 0x69, 0x6e, 0x67, 0x2e, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0, ++ 0x48, 0x54, 0x54, 0x50, 0x2f, 0x31, 0x2e, 0x30, 0x20, 0x32, ++ 0x30, 0x30, 0x20, 0x4f, 0x4b, 0xd, 0xa, 0x53, 0x65, 0x72, ++ 0x76, 0x65, 0x72, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x75, 0x49, 0x50, 0x2f, 0x30, ++ 0x2e, 0x39, 0x20, 0x28, 0x68, 0x74, 0x74, 0x70, 0x3a, 0x2f, ++ 0x2f, 0x64, 0x75, 0x6e, 0x6b, 0x65, 0x6c, 0x73, 0x2e, 0x63, ++ 0x6f, 0x6d, 0x2f, 0x61, 0x64, 0x61, 0x6d, 0x2f, 0x75, 0x69, ++ 0x70, 0x2f, 0x29, 0xd, 0xa, 0x43, 0x6f, 0x6e, 0x74, 0x65, ++ 0x6e, 0x74, 0x2d, 0x74, 0x79, 0x70, 0x65, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x74, ++ 0x65, 0x78, 0x74, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0xd, 0xa, ++ 0xd, 0xa, 0x3c, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0x3e, 0x3c, 0x62, ++ 0x6f, 0x64, 0x79, 0x20, 0x73, 0x74, 0x79, 0x6c, 0x65, 0x3d, ++ 0x22, 0x6d, 0x61, 0x72, 0x67, 0x69, 0x6e, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x30, ++ 0x70, 0x74, 0x20, 0x61, 0x75, 0x74, 0x6f, 0x3b, 0x20, 0x68, ++ 0x65, 0x69, 0x67, 0x68, 0x74, 0x3a, 0x31, 0x30, 0x30, 0x25, ++ 0x3b, 0x20, 0x63, 0x6f, 0x6c, 0x6f, 0x72, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x23, ++ 0x66, 0x66, 0x66, 0x3b, 0x20, 0x62, 0x61, 0x63, 0x6b, 0x67, ++ 0x72, 0x6f, 0x75, 0x6e, 0x64, 0x2d, 0x63, 0x6f, 0x6c, 0x6f, ++ 0x72, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x23, 0x66, 0x62, 0x62, 0x30, 0x33, 0x34, ++ 0x3b, 0x22, 0x3e, 0x3c, 0x63, 0x65, 0x6e, 0x74, 0x65, 0x72, ++ 0x3e, 0x3c, 0x68, 0x31, 0x3e, 0x55, 0x70, 0x67, 0x72, 0x61, ++ 0x64, 0x69, 0x6e, 0x67, 0x20, 0x73, 0x79, 0x73, 0x74, 0x65, ++ 0x6d, 0x20, 0x2e, 0x2e, 0x2e, 0x2e, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x31, ++ 0x3e, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x63, 0x65, 0x6e, 0x74, 0x65, 0x72, 0x3e, ++ 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x62, 0x6f, 0x64, 0x79, 0x3e, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x68, ++ 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0x3e, 0xa, }; ++ ++static const char data_fail_html[] = { ++ /* /fail.html */ ++ 0x2f, 0x66, 0x61, 0x69, 0x6c, 0x2e, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0, ++ 0x48, 0x54, 0x54, 0x50, 0x2f, 0x31, 0x2e, 0x30, 0x20, 0x32, ++ 0x30, 0x30, 0x20, 0x4f, 0x4b, 0xd, 0xa, 0x53, 0x65, 0x72, ++ 0x76, 0x65, 0x72, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x75, 0x49, 0x50, 0x2f, 0x30, ++ 0x2e, 0x39, 0x20, 0x28, 0x68, 0x74, 0x74, 0x70, 0x3a, 0x2f, ++ 0x2f, 0x64, 0x75, 0x6e, 0x6b, 0x65, 0x6c, 0x73, 0x2e, 0x63, ++ 0x6f, 0x6d, 0x2f, 0x61, 0x64, 0x61, 0x6d, 0x2f, 0x75, 0x69, ++ 0x70, 0x2f, 0x29, 0xd, 0xa, 0x43, 0x6f, 0x6e, 0x74, 0x65, ++ 0x6e, 0x74, 0x2d, 0x74, 0x79, 0x70, 0x65, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x74, ++ 0x65, 0x78, 0x74, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0xd, 0xa, ++ 0xd, 0xa, 0x3c, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, ++ 0x3c, 0x68, 0x65, 0x61, 0x64, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, 0x3c, ++ 0x74, 0x69, 0x74, 0x6c, 0x65, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, 0x9, ++ 0x4c, 0x61, 0x46, 0x6f, 0x6e, 0x65, 0x72, 0x61, 0x20, 0x46, ++ 0x61, 0x69, 0x6c, 0x73, 0x61, 0x66, 0x65, 0x20, 0x55, 0x49, ++ 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x74, 0x69, 0x74, 0x6c, 0x65, ++ 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x62, 0x6f, 0x64, 0x79, 0x3e, 0xa, ++ 0x9, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x68, 0x31, 0x3e, 0x46, 0x6c, 0x61, 0x73, ++ 0x68, 0x69, 0x6e, 0x67, 0x20, 0x66, 0x61, 0x69, 0x6c, 0x65, ++ 0x64, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x31, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, 0x45, ++ 0x52, 0x52, 0x4f, 0x52, 0x20, 0x2d, 0x20, 0x74, 0x68, 0x65, ++ 0x20, 0x69, 0x6d, 0x61, 0x67, 0x65, 0x20, 0x79, 0x6f, 0x75, ++ 0x20, 0x75, 0x70, 0x6c, 0x6f, 0x61, 0x64, 0x65, 0x64, 0x20, ++ 0x66, 0x61, 0x69, 0x6c, 0x65, 0x64, 0x20, 0x74, 0x6f, 0x20, ++ 0x70, 0x61, 0x73, 0x73, 0x20, 0x76, 0x65, 0x72, 0x69, 0x66, ++ 0x69, 0x63, 0x61, 0x74, 0x69, 0x6f, 0x6e, 0x2e, 0x20, 0x50, ++ 0x6c, 0x65, 0x61, 0x73, 0x65, 0x20, 0x6d, 0x61, 0x6b, 0x65, ++ 0x20, 0x73, 0x75, 0x72, 0x65, 0x20, 0x74, 0x6f, 0x20, 0x75, ++ 0x73, 0x65, 0x20, 0x61, 0x6e, 0x20, 0x6f, 0x66, 0x66, 0x69, ++ 0x63, 0x69, 0x61, 0x6c, 0x20, 0x75, 0x70, 0x64, 0x61, 0x74, ++ 0x65, 0x20, 0x70, 0x72, 0x6f, 0x76, 0x69, 0x64, 0x65, 0x64, ++ 0x20, 0x62, 0x79, 0x20, 0x68, 0x74, 0x74, 0x70, 0x3a, 0x2f, ++ 0x2f, 0x64, 0x6f, 0x77, 0x6e, 0x6c, 0x6f, 0x61, 0x64, 0x2e, ++ 0x66, 0x6f, 0x6e, 0x6f, 0x73, 0x66, 0x65, 0x72, 0x61, 0x2e, ++ 0x6f, 0x72, 0x67, 0x2f, 0xa, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x62, 0x6f, ++ 0x64, 0x79, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, ++ 0x3e, 0xa, }; ++ ++static const char data_404_html[] = { ++ /* /404.html */ ++ 0x2f, 0x34, 0x30, 0x34, 0x2e, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0, ++ 0x48, 0x54, 0x54, 0x50, 0x2f, 0x31, 0x2e, 0x30, 0x20, 0x34, ++ 0x30, 0x34, 0x20, 0x46, 0x69, 0x6c, 0x65, 0x20, 0x6e, 0x6f, ++ 0x74, 0x20, 0x66, 0x6f, 0x75, 0x6e, 0x64, 0xd, 0xa, 0x53, ++ 0x65, 0x72, 0x76, 0x65, 0x72, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x75, 0x49, 0x50, ++ 0x2f, 0x30, 0x2e, 0x39, 0x20, 0x28, 0x68, 0x74, 0x74, 0x70, ++ 0x3a, 0x2f, 0x2f, 0x64, 0x75, 0x6e, 0x6b, 0x65, 0x6c, 0x73, ++ 0x2e, 0x63, 0x6f, 0x6d, 0x2f, 0x61, 0x64, 0x61, 0x6d, 0x2f, ++ 0x75, 0x69, 0x70, 0x2f, 0x29, 0xd, 0xa, 0x43, 0x6f, 0x6e, ++ 0x74, 0x65, 0x6e, 0x74, 0x2d, 0x74, 0x79, 0x70, 0x65, 0x3a, ++ 0x20, 0x74, 0x65, 0x78, 0x74, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, ++ 0xd, 0xa, 0xd, 0xa, 0x3c, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0x3e, ++ 0x3c, 0x62, 0x6f, 0x64, 0x79, 0x20, 0x62, 0x67, 0x63, 0x6f, ++ 0x6c, 0x6f, 0x72, 0x3d, 0x22, 0x77, 0x68, 0x69, 0x74, 0x65, ++ 0x22, 0x3e, 0x3c, 0x63, 0x65, 0x6e, 0x74, 0x65, 0x72, 0x3e, ++ 0x3c, 0x68, 0x31, 0x3e, 0x34, 0x30, 0x34, 0x20, 0x2d, 0x20, ++ 0x66, 0x69, 0x6c, 0x65, 0x20, 0x6e, 0x6f, 0x74, 0x20, 0x66, ++ 0x6f, 0x75, 0x6e, 0x64, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x31, 0x3e, 0x3c, ++ 0x2f, 0x63, 0x65, 0x6e, 0x74, 0x65, 0x72, 0x3e, 0x3c, 0x2f, ++ 0x62, 0x6f, 0x64, 0x79, 0x3e, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, ++ 0x6c, 0x3e, }; ++ ++static const char data_index_html[] = { ++ /* /index.html */ ++ 0x2f, 0x69, 0x6e, 0x64, 0x65, 0x78, 0x2e, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0, ++ 0x48, 0x54, 0x54, 0x50, 0x2f, 0x31, 0x2e, 0x30, 0x20, 0x32, ++ 0x30, 0x30, 0x20, 0x4f, 0x4b, 0xd, 0xa, 0x53, 0x65, 0x72, ++ 0x76, 0x65, 0x72, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x75, 0x49, 0x50, 0x2f, 0x30, ++ 0x2e, 0x39, 0x20, 0x28, 0x68, 0x74, 0x74, 0x70, 0x3a, 0x2f, ++ 0x2f, 0x64, 0x75, 0x6e, 0x6b, 0x65, 0x6c, 0x73, 0x2e, 0x63, ++ 0x6f, 0x6d, 0x2f, 0x61, 0x64, 0x61, 0x6d, 0x2f, 0x75, 0x69, ++ 0x70, 0x2f, 0x29, 0xd, 0xa, 0x43, 0x6f, 0x6e, 0x74, 0x65, ++ 0x6e, 0x74, 0x2d, 0x74, 0x79, 0x70, 0x65, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x74, ++ 0x65, 0x78, 0x74, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0xd, 0xa, ++ 0xd, 0xa, 0x3c, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, ++ 0x3c, 0x68, 0x65, 0x61, 0x64, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, 0x3c, ++ 0x74, 0x69, 0x74, 0x6c, 0x65, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, 0x9, ++ 0x4c, 0x61, 0x46, 0x6f, 0x6e, 0x65, 0x72, 0x61, 0x20, 0x46, ++ 0x61, 0x69, 0x6c, 0x73, 0x61, 0x66, 0x65, 0x20, 0x55, 0x49, ++ 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x74, 0x69, 0x74, 0x6c, 0x65, ++ 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x65, 0x61, 0x64, 0x3e, ++ 0xa, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x62, 0x6f, 0x64, 0x79, 0x20, 0x73, 0x74, ++ 0x79, 0x6c, 0x65, 0x3d, 0x22, 0x6d, 0x61, 0x72, 0x67, 0x69, ++ 0x6e, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x30, 0x70, 0x74, 0x20, 0x61, 0x75, 0x74, ++ 0x6f, 0x3b, 0x20, 0x68, 0x65, 0x69, 0x67, 0x68, 0x74, 0x3a, ++ 0x31, 0x30, 0x30, 0x25, 0x3b, 0x20, 0x63, 0x6f, 0x6c, 0x6f, ++ 0x72, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x23, 0x30, 0x30, 0x30, 0x3b, 0x20, 0x62, ++ 0x61, 0x63, 0x6b, 0x67, 0x72, 0x6f, 0x75, 0x6e, 0x64, 0x2d, ++ 0x63, 0x6f, 0x6c, 0x6f, 0x72, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x23, 0x66, 0x62, ++ 0x62, 0x30, 0x33, 0x34, 0x3b, 0x22, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, ++ 0x3c, 0x68, 0x31, 0x3e, 0x4c, 0x61, 0x46, 0x6f, 0x6e, 0x65, ++ 0x72, 0x61, 0x20, 0x46, 0x61, 0x69, 0x6c, 0x73, 0x61, 0x66, ++ 0x65, 0x20, 0x55, 0x49, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x31, 0x3e, 0xa, ++ 0x9, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x66, 0x6f, 0x72, 0x6d, 0x20, 0x6d, 0x65, ++ 0x74, 0x68, 0x6f, 0x64, 0x3d, 0x22, 0x70, 0x6f, 0x73, 0x74, ++ 0x22, 0x20, 0x65, 0x6e, 0x63, 0x74, 0x79, 0x70, 0x65, 0x3d, ++ 0x22, 0x6d, 0x75, 0x6c, 0x74, 0x69, 0x70, 0x61, 0x72, 0x74, ++ 0x2f, 0x66, 0x6f, 0x72, 0x6d, 0x2d, 0x64, 0x61, 0x74, 0x61, ++ 0x22, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x69, 0x6e, 0x70, ++ 0x75, 0x74, 0x20, 0x74, 0x79, 0x70, 0x65, 0x3d, 0x66, 0x69, ++ 0x6c, 0x65, 0x20, 0x6e, 0x61, 0x6d, 0x65, 0x3d, 0x66, 0x69, ++ 0x72, 0x6d, 0x77, 0x61, 0x72, 0x65, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, ++ 0x9, 0x3c, 0x69, 0x6e, 0x70, 0x75, 0x74, 0x20, 0x74, 0x79, ++ 0x70, 0x65, 0x3d, 0x73, 0x75, 0x62, 0x6d, 0x69, 0x74, 0x3e, ++ 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x66, 0x6f, 0x72, 0x6d, 0x3e, ++ 0xa, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x62, 0x6f, 0x64, 0x79, 0x3e, 0xa, ++ 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0x3e, 0xa, }; ++ ++static const char data_flash_html[] = { ++ /* /flash.html */ ++ 0x2f, 0x66, 0x6c, 0x61, 0x73, 0x68, 0x2e, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0, ++ 0x48, 0x54, 0x54, 0x50, 0x2f, 0x31, 0x2e, 0x30, 0x20, 0x32, ++ 0x30, 0x30, 0x20, 0x4f, 0x4b, 0xd, 0xa, 0x53, 0x65, 0x72, ++ 0x76, 0x65, 0x72, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x75, 0x49, 0x50, 0x2f, 0x30, ++ 0x2e, 0x39, 0x20, 0x28, 0x68, 0x74, 0x74, 0x70, 0x3a, 0x2f, ++ 0x2f, 0x64, 0x75, 0x6e, 0x6b, 0x65, 0x6c, 0x73, 0x2e, 0x63, ++ 0x6f, 0x6d, 0x2f, 0x61, 0x64, 0x61, 0x6d, 0x2f, 0x75, 0x69, ++ 0x70, 0x2f, 0x29, 0xd, 0xa, 0x43, 0x6f, 0x6e, 0x74, 0x65, ++ 0x6e, 0x74, 0x2d, 0x74, 0x79, 0x70, 0x65, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x74, ++ 0x65, 0x78, 0x74, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0xd, 0xa, ++ 0xd, 0xa, 0x3c, 0x68, 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, ++ 0x3c, 0x68, 0x65, 0x61, 0x64, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, 0x3c, ++ 0x74, 0x69, 0x74, 0x6c, 0x65, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, 0x9, ++ 0x4c, 0x61, 0x46, 0x6f, 0x6e, 0x65, 0x72, 0x61, 0x20, 0x46, ++ 0x61, 0x69, 0x6c, 0x73, 0x61, 0x66, 0x65, 0x20, 0x55, 0x49, ++ 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x74, 0x69, 0x74, 0x6c, 0x65, ++ 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x65, 0x61, 0x64, 0x3e, ++ 0xa, 0x9, 0x3c, 0x62, 0x6f, 0x64, 0x79, 0x20, 0x73, 0x74, ++ 0x79, 0x6c, 0x65, 0x3d, 0x22, 0x6d, 0x61, 0x72, 0x67, 0x69, ++ 0x6e, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x30, 0x70, 0x74, 0x20, 0x61, 0x75, 0x74, ++ 0x6f, 0x3b, 0x20, 0x68, 0x65, 0x69, 0x67, 0x68, 0x74, 0x3a, ++ 0x31, 0x30, 0x30, 0x25, 0x3b, 0x20, 0x63, 0x6f, 0x6c, 0x6f, ++ 0x72, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x23, 0x30, 0x30, 0x30, 0x3b, 0x20, 0x62, ++ 0x61, 0x63, 0x6b, 0x67, 0x72, 0x6f, 0x75, 0x6e, 0x64, 0x2d, ++ 0x63, 0x6f, 0x6c, 0x6f, 0x72, 0x3a, 0x20, 0x23, 0x66, 0x62, ++ 0x62, 0x30, 0x33, 0x34, 0x3b, 0x22, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, ++ 0x3c, 0x68, 0x31, 0x3e, 0x46, 0x6c, 0x61, 0x73, 0x68, 0x69, ++ 0x6e, 0x67, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x68, 0x31, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x9, 0x9, ++ 0x54, 0x68, 0x65, 0x20, 0x73, 0x79, 0x73, 0x74, 0x65, 0x6d, ++ 0x20, 0x69, 0x73, 0x20, 0x6e, 0x6f, 0x77, 0x20, 0x74, 0x72, ++ 0x79, 0x69, 0x6e, 0x67, 0x20, 0x74, 0x6f, 0x20, 0x66, 0x6c, ++ 0x61, 0x73, 0x68, 0x2e, 0x20, 0x49, 0x66, 0x20, 0x74, 0x68, ++ 0x65, 0x72, 0x65, 0x20, 0x69, 0x73, 0x20, 0x61, 0x20, 0x70, ++ 0x72, 0x6f, 0x62, 0x6c, 0x65, 0x6d, 0x2c, 0x20, 0x74, 0x68, ++ 0x65, 0x20, 0x6c, 0x65, 0x64, 0x73, 0x20, 0x77, 0x69, 0x6c, ++ 0x6c, 0x20, 0x73, 0x74, 0x61, 0x72, 0x74, 0x20, 0x74, 0x6f, ++ 0x20, 0x62, 0x6c, 0x69, 0x6e, 0x6b, 0x2e, 0xa, 0xa, 0x9, ++ 0x9, 0x41, 0x66, 0x74, 0x65, 0x72, 0x20, 0x61, 0x20, 0x73, ++ 0x75, 0x63, 0x63, 0x65, 0x73, 0x73, 0x66, 0x75, 0x6c, 0x6c, ++ 0x20, 0x75, 0x70, 0x64, 0x61, 0x74, 0x65, 0x20, 0x74, 0x68, ++ 0x65, 0x20, 0x62, 0x6f, 0x78, 0x20, 0x77, 0x69, 0x6c, 0x6c, ++ 0x20, 0x72, 0x65, 0x62, 0x6f, 0x6f, 0x74, 0xa, 0x9, 0x3c, ++ 0x2f, 0x62, 0x6f, 0x64, 0x79, 0x3e, 0xa, 0x3c, 0x2f, 0x68, ++ 0x74, 0x6d, 0x6c, 0x3e, 0xa, }; ++ ++const struct fsdata_file file_flashing_html[] = {{NULL, data_flashing_html, data_flashing_html + 15, sizeof(data_flashing_html) - 15}}; ++ ++const struct fsdata_file file_fail_html[] = {{file_flashing_html, data_fail_html, data_fail_html + 11, sizeof(data_fail_html) - 11}}; ++ ++const struct fsdata_file file_404_html[] = {{file_fail_html, data_404_html, data_404_html + 10, sizeof(data_404_html) - 10}}; ++ ++const struct fsdata_file file_index_html[] = {{file_404_html, data_index_html, data_index_html + 12, sizeof(data_index_html) - 12}}; ++ ++const struct fsdata_file file_flash_html[] = {{file_index_html, data_flash_html, data_flash_html + 12, sizeof(data_flash_html) - 12}}; ++ ++#define FS_ROOT file_flash_html ++ ++#define FS_NUMFILES 5 +\ No newline at end of file +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/fsdata.h +@@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001, Swedish Institute of Computer Science. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors ++ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software ++ * without specific prior written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND ++ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE ++ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE ++ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS ++ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) ++ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT ++ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY ++ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF ++ * SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * This file is part of the lwIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * ++ * Author: Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> ++ * ++ * $Id: fsdata.h,v 1.4.2.1 2003/10/04 22:54:06 adam Exp $ ++ */ ++#ifndef __FSDATA_H__ ++#define __FSDATA_H__ ++ ++#include "uipopt.h" ++ ++struct fsdata_file { ++ const struct fsdata_file *next; ++ const char *name; ++ const char *data; ++ const int len; ++#ifdef FS_STATISTICS ++#if FS_STATISTICS == 1 ++ u16_t count; ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++}; ++ ++struct fsdata_file_noconst { ++ struct fsdata_file *next; ++ char *name; ++ char *data; ++ int len; ++#ifdef FS_STATISTICS ++#if FS_STATISTICS == 1 ++ u16_t count; ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++}; ++ ++#endif /* __FSDATA_H__ */ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/fs.h +@@ -0,0 +1,80 @@ ++/** ++ * \addtogroup httpd ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \file ++ * HTTP server read-only file system header file. ++ * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> ++ */ ++ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001, Swedish Institute of Computer Science. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors ++ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software ++ * without specific prior written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND ++ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE ++ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE ++ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS ++ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) ++ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT ++ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY ++ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF ++ * SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * This file is part of the lwIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * ++ * Author: Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> ++ * ++ * $Id: fs.h,v 1.6.2.3 2003/10/07 13:22:27 adam Exp $ ++ */ ++#ifndef __FS_H__ ++#define __FS_H__ ++ ++#include "uip.h" ++ ++/** ++ * An open file in the read-only file system. ++ */ ++struct fs_file { ++ char *data; /**< The actual file data. */ ++ int len; /**< The length of the file data. */ ++}; ++ ++/** ++ * Open a file in the read-only file system. ++ * ++ * \param name The name of the file. ++ * ++ * \param file The file pointer, which must be allocated by caller and ++ * will be filled in by the function. ++ */ ++int fs_open(const char *name, struct fs_file *file); ++ ++#ifdef FS_STATISTICS ++#if FS_STATISTICS == 1 ++u16_t fs_count(char *name); ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++#endif /* FS_STATISTICS */ ++ ++/** ++ * Initialize the read-only file system. ++ */ ++void fs_init(void); ++ ++#endif /* __FS_H__ */ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/httpd.c +@@ -0,0 +1,278 @@ ++#include "uip.h" ++#include "httpd.h" ++#include "fs.h" ++#include "fsdata.h" ++#include <asm/addrspace.h> ++ ++#define HTTP_NONE 0 ++#define HTTP_FILE 1 ++#define HTTP_FIRMWARE 2 ++ ++#define PRINT(x) printf("%s", x) ++#define PRINTLN(x) printf("%s\n", x) ++ ++extern unsigned long do_http_tmp_address(void); ++ ++struct httpd_state *hs; ++ ++extern const struct fsdata_file file_index_html; ++extern const struct fsdata_file file_404_html; ++extern const struct fsdata_file file_flash_html; ++extern int httpd_upload_complete; ++extern unsigned char *httpd_upload_data; ++unsigned char *upload_data; ++extern ulong NetBootFileXferSize; ++int upload_running = 0; ++ ++#define ISO_G 0x47 ++#define ISO_E 0x45 ++#define ISO_T 0x54 ++#define ISO_P 0x50 ++#define ISO_O 0x4f ++#define ISO_S 0x53 ++#define ISO_T 0x54 ++#define ISO_slash 0x2f ++#define ISO_c 0x63 ++#define ISO_g 0x67 ++#define ISO_i 0x69 ++#define ISO_space 0x20 ++#define ISO_nl 0x0a ++#define ISO_cr 0x0d ++#define ISO_a 0x61 ++#define ISO_t 0x74 ++#define ISO_hash 0x23 ++#define ISO_period 0x2e ++ ++static char eol[3] = { 0x0d, 0x0a, 0x00 }; ++static char eol2[5] = { 0x0d, 0x0a, 0x0d, 0x0a, 0x00 }; ++static char boundary[128]; ++static int boundary_len = 0; ++ ++/* we use this so that we can do without the ctype library */ ++#define is_digit(c) ((c) >= '0' && (c) <= '9') ++static int atoi(const char *s) ++{ ++ int i=0; ++ ++ while (is_digit(*s)) ++ i = i*10 + *(s++) - '0'; ++ return i; ++} ++ ++void ++httpd_init(void) ++{ ++ fs_init(); ++ uip_listen(HTONS(80)); ++} ++ ++void ++httpd_appcall(void) ++{ ++ struct fs_file fsfile; ++ u8_t i; ++ switch(uip_conn->lport) { ++ case HTONS(80): ++ hs = (struct httpd_state *)(uip_conn->appstate); ++ if(uip_connected()) ++ { ++ hs->state = HTTP_NONE; ++ hs->count = 0; ++ return; ++ } else if(uip_poll()) ++ { ++ if(hs->count++ >= 1000) { ++ uip_abort(); ++ } ++ return; ++ } else if(uip_newdata() && hs->state == HTTP_NONE) ++ { ++ if(uip_appdata[0] == ISO_G && ++ uip_appdata[1] == ISO_E && ++ uip_appdata[2] == ISO_T && ++ uip_appdata[3] == ISO_space) ++ { ++ hs->state = HTTP_FILE; ++ } ++ if(uip_appdata[0] == ISO_P && ++ uip_appdata[1] == ISO_O && ++ uip_appdata[2] == ISO_S && ++ uip_appdata[3] == ISO_T && ++ uip_appdata[4] == ISO_space) ++ { ++ hs->state = HTTP_FIRMWARE; ++ } ++ if(hs->state == HTTP_NONE) ++ { ++ uip_abort(); ++ return; ++ } ++ if(hs->state == HTTP_FILE) ++ { ++ for(i = 4; i < 40; ++i) ++ { ++ if(uip_appdata[i] == ISO_space || ++ uip_appdata[i] == ISO_cr || ++ uip_appdata[i] == ISO_nl) ++ { ++ uip_appdata[i] = 0; ++ break; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ PRINT("request for file "); ++ PRINTLN(&uip_appdata[4]); ++ if(uip_appdata[4] == ISO_slash && ++ uip_appdata[5] == 0) ++ { ++ fs_open(file_index_html.name, &fsfile); ++ } else { ++ if(!fs_open((const char *)&uip_appdata[4], &fsfile)) ++ { ++ PRINTLN("couldn't open file"); ++ fs_open(file_index_html.name, &fsfile); ++ } ++ } ++ hs->script = 0; ++ hs->state = HTTP_FILE; ++ hs->dataptr = fsfile.data; ++ hs->count = fsfile.len; ++ } ++ if(hs->state == HTTP_FIRMWARE) ++ { ++ unsigned char *start = (unsigned char*)uip_appdata; ++ char *clen = strstr(start, "Content-Length:"); ++ int len = 0; ++ unsigned char *next, *end; ++ unsigned char *boundary_start; ++ int i; ++ uip_appdata[uip_len] = '\0'; ++ if(clen) ++ { ++ clen += sizeof("Content-Length:"); ++ next = strstr(clen, eol); ++ if(next) ++ { ++ len = atoi(clen); ++ next++; ++ printf("expecting %d bytes\n", len); ++ upload_data = httpd_upload_data = (unsigned char *)do_http_tmp_address(); ++ printf("received data will be stored at 0x%08X\n", upload_data); ++ if(!upload_data) ++ { ++ printf("failed to allocate memory\n"); ++ uip_close(); ++ return; ++ } ++ } else { ++ uip_close(); ++ return; ++ } ++ } ++ if(len < 4 * 1024) ++ { ++ uip_close(); ++ return; ++ } ++ boundary_start = strstr(next, "---"); ++ if(!boundary_start) ++ { ++ uip_close(); ++ return; ++ } ++ end = strstr(boundary_start, eol); ++ if(!eol) ++ { ++ uip_close(); ++ return; ++ } ++ boundary_len = end - boundary_start; ++ memcpy(boundary, boundary_start, boundary_len); ++ boundary[boundary_len] = 0; ++ next = strstr(boundary_start, "name=\"firmware\";"); ++ if(!next) ++ { ++ uip_close(); ++ return; ++ } ++ next = strstr(next, eol2); ++ if(!next) ++ { ++ printf("could not find start of data\n"); ++ uip_close(); ++ return; ++ } ++ next += 4; ++ hs->script = 0; ++ hs->state = HTTP_FIRMWARE; ++ hs->upload = uip_len - (next - start); ++ hs->upload_total = len - (int)(next - boundary_start); ++ hs->upload_total -= (strlen(boundary) + 6); ++ //printf("storing %d bytes at %p\n", (int)hs->upload, upload_data); ++ for(i = 0; i < hs->upload; i++) ++ upload_data[i] = next[i]; ++ upload_data += (int)hs->upload; ++ printf("%d / %d\n", (int)hs->upload, hs->upload_total); ++ uip_slen = 0; ++ return; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ if(hs->state == HTTP_FIRMWARE) ++ { ++ if(uip_newdata()) ++ { ++ int i; ++ hs->count = 0; ++ uip_appdata[uip_len] = '\0'; ++ hs->upload += uip_len; ++ //printf("storing %d bytes at %p\n", uip_len, upload_data); ++ printf("%d / %d\n", (int)hs->upload, hs->upload_total); ++ for(i = 0; i < uip_len; i++) ++ upload_data[i] = uip_appdata[i]; ++ upload_data += uip_len; ++ uip_slen = 0; ++ if(hs->upload >= hs->upload_total) ++ { ++ upload_running = 1; ++ NetBootFileXferSize = hs->upload_total; ++ fs_open(file_flash_html.name, &fsfile); ++ hs->script = 0; ++ hs->state = HTTP_FILE; ++ hs->dataptr = fsfile.data; ++ hs->count = fsfile.len; ++ } ++ } ++ } ++ if(hs->state == HTTP_FILE) ++ { ++ if(uip_acked()) ++ { ++ if(hs->count >= uip_conn->len) ++ { ++ hs->count -= uip_conn->len; ++ hs->dataptr += uip_conn->len; ++ } else { ++ hs->count = 0; ++ } ++ if(hs->count == 0) ++ { ++ if(upload_running) ++ { ++ int i; ++ httpd_upload_complete = 1; ++ // for(i = 0; i < hs->upload_total; i++) ++ // printf("%c", httpd_upload_data[i]); ++ } ++ uip_close(); ++ } ++ } ++ uip_send(hs->dataptr, hs->count); ++ } ++ break; ++ ++ default: ++ uip_abort(); ++ break; ++ } ++} +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/httpd.h +@@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ ++/** ++ * \addtogroup httpd ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \file ++ * HTTP server header file. ++ * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> ++ */ ++ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001, Adam Dunkels. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote ++ * products derived from this software without specific prior ++ * written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS ++ * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED ++ * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY ++ * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE ++ * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS ++ * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ++ * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING ++ * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS ++ * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * ++ * $Id: httpd.h,v 1.4.2.3 2003/10/06 22:56:44 adam Exp $ ++ * ++ */ ++ ++#ifndef __HTTPD_H__ ++#define __HTTPD_H__ ++ ++void httpd_init(void); ++void httpd_appcall(void); ++ ++/* UIP_APPCALL: the name of the application function. This function ++ must return void and take no arguments (i.e., C type "void ++ appfunc(void)"). */ ++#ifndef UIP_APPCALL ++#define UIP_APPCALL httpd_appcall ++#endif ++ ++struct httpd_state { ++ u8_t state; ++ u16_t count; ++ char *dataptr; ++ char *script; ++ unsigned int upload; ++ unsigned int upload_total; ++}; ++ ++ ++/* UIP_APPSTATE_SIZE: The size of the application-specific state ++ stored in the uip_conn structure. */ ++#ifndef UIP_APPSTATE_SIZE ++#define UIP_APPSTATE_SIZE (sizeof(struct httpd_state)) ++#endif ++ ++#define FS_STATISTICS 1 ++ ++extern struct httpd_state *hs; ++ ++ ++/* we copy the data to RAM+10MB */ ++#define TMP_DATA 0x8A100000 ++ ++#endif /* __HTTPD_H__ */ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/main.c +@@ -0,0 +1,88 @@ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote ++ * products derived from this software without specific prior ++ * written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS ++ * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED ++ * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY ++ * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE ++ * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS ++ * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ++ * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING ++ * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS ++ * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * ++ * $Id: main.c,v 1.10.2.1 2003/10/04 22:54:17 adam Exp $ ++ * ++ */ ++ ++ ++#include "uip.h" ++#include "uip_arp.h" ++#include "tapdev.h" ++#include "httpd.h" ++ ++#define BUF ((struct uip_eth_hdr *)&uip_buf[0]) ++ ++#ifndef NULL ++#define NULL (void *)0 ++#endif /* NULL */ ++ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++int ++main(void) ++{ ++ u8_t i, arptimer; ++ tapdev_init(); ++ uip_init(); ++ httpd_init(); ++ arptimer = 0; ++ while(1) { ++ uip_len = tapdev_read(); ++ if(uip_len == 0) { ++ for(i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; i++) { ++ uip_periodic(i); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ uip_arp_out(); ++ tapdev_send(); ++ } ++ } ++ ++ if(++arptimer == 20) { ++ uip_arp_timer(); ++ arptimer = 0; ++ } ++ } else { ++ if(BUF->type == htons(UIP_ETHTYPE_IP)) { ++ uip_arp_ipin(); ++ uip_input(); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ uip_arp_out(); ++ tapdev_send(); ++ } ++ } else if(BUF->type == htons(UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP)) { ++ uip_arp_arpin(); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ tapdev_send(); ++ } ++ } ++ } ++ } ++ return 0; ++} +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/Makefile +@@ -0,0 +1,54 @@ ++# Copyright (c) 2001, Adam Dunkels. ++# All rights reserved. ++# ++# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++# are met: ++# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++# 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software ++# must display the following acknowledgement: ++# This product includes software developed by Adam Dunkels. ++# 4. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote ++# products derived from this software without specific prior ++# written permission. ++# ++# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS ++# OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED ++# WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY ++# DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE ++# GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS ++# INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ++# WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING ++# NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS ++# SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ++# ++# This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. ++# ++# $Id: Makefile,v 1.8.2.2 2003/10/04 22:54:17 adam Exp $ ++# ++ ++CC=gcc ++CFLAGS=-Wall -fpack-struct -DDUMP=0 ++ ++all: uip ++ ++uip: uip.o uip_arch.o tapdev.o httpd.o main.o fs.o uip_arp.o ++ $(CC) $(CFLAGS) $(LDFLAGS) $^ -o $@ ++ ++%.o: %.c ++ $(CC) $(CFLAGS) -c $^ -o $@ ++ ++clean: ++ rm -f *.o *~ *core uip ++ ++ ++ ++ ++ ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/tapdev.c +@@ -0,0 +1,192 @@ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001, Swedish Institute of Computer Science. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * ++ * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors ++ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software ++ * without specific prior written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND ++ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE ++ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE ++ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS ++ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) ++ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT ++ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY ++ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF ++ * SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * Author: Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> ++ * ++ * $Id: tapdev.c,v 1.7.2.1 2003/10/07 13:23:19 adam Exp $ ++ */ ++ ++ ++#include <fcntl.h> ++#include <stdlib.h> ++#include <stdio.h> ++#include <unistd.h> ++#include <string.h> ++#include <sys/ioctl.h> ++#include <sys/socket.h> ++#include <sys/types.h> ++#include <sys/time.h> ++#include <sys/uio.h> ++#include <sys/socket.h> ++ ++#ifdef linux ++#include <sys/ioctl.h> ++#include <linux/if.h> ++#include <linux/if_tun.h> ++#define DEVTAP "/dev/net/tun" ++#else /* linux */ ++#define DEVTAP "/dev/tap0" ++#endif /* linux */ ++ ++#include "uip.h" ++ ++static int fd; ++ ++static unsigned long lasttime; ++static struct timezone tz; ++ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++void ++tapdev_init(void) ++{ ++ char buf[1024]; ++ ++ fd = open(DEVTAP, O_RDWR); ++ if(fd == -1) { ++ perror("tapdev: tapdev_init: open"); ++ exit(1); ++ } ++ ++#ifdef linux ++ { ++ struct ifreq ifr; ++ memset(&ifr, 0, sizeof(ifr)); ++ ifr.ifr_flags = IFF_TAP|IFF_NO_PI; ++ if (ioctl(fd, TUNSETIFF, (void *) &ifr) < 0) { ++ perror(buf); ++ exit(1); ++ } ++ } ++#endif /* Linux */ ++ ++ snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "ifconfig tap0 inet %d.%d.%d.%d", ++ UIP_DRIPADDR0, UIP_DRIPADDR1, UIP_DRIPADDR2, UIP_DRIPADDR3); ++ system(buf); ++ ++ lasttime = 0; ++} ++ ++void dump_mem(int type, int len) ++{ ++#if DUMP == 1 ++ int i; ++ for(i = 0; i < len; i++) ++ printf("%c", uip_buf[i]); ++ if(type) ++ { ++ printf("\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01"); ++ printf("\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01\01"); ++ } else { ++ printf("\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02"); ++ printf("\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02\02"); ++ } ++ fflush(stdout); ++#endif ++} ++ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++unsigned int ++tapdev_read(void) ++{ ++ fd_set fdset; ++ struct timeval tv, now; ++ int ret; ++ ++ if(lasttime >= 500000) { ++ lasttime = 0; ++ return 0; ++ } ++ ++ tv.tv_sec = 0; ++ tv.tv_usec = 500000 - lasttime; ++ ++ ++ FD_ZERO(&fdset); ++ FD_SET(fd, &fdset); ++ ++ gettimeofday(&now, &tz); ++ ret = select(fd + 1, &fdset, NULL, NULL, &tv); ++ if(ret == 0) { ++ lasttime = 0; ++ return 0; ++ } ++ ret = read(fd, uip_buf, UIP_BUFSIZE); ++ if(ret == -1) { ++ perror("tap_dev: tapdev_read: read"); ++ } ++ gettimeofday(&tv, &tz); ++ lasttime += (tv.tv_sec - now.tv_sec) * 1000000 + (tv.tv_usec - now.tv_usec); ++ dump_mem(0, ret); ++ return ret; ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++void ++tapdev_send(void) ++{ ++ int ret; ++ struct iovec iov[2]; ++ ++#ifdef linux ++ { ++ char tmpbuf[UIP_BUFSIZE]; ++ int i; ++ ++ for(i = 0; i < 40 + UIP_LLH_LEN; i++) { ++ tmpbuf[i] = uip_buf[i]; ++ } ++ ++ for(; i < uip_len; i++) { ++ tmpbuf[i] = uip_appdata[i - 40 - UIP_LLH_LEN]; ++ } ++ ++ ret = write(fd, tmpbuf, uip_len); ++ } ++#else ++ ++ if(uip_len < 40 + UIP_LLH_LEN) { ++ ret = write(fd, uip_buf, uip_len + UIP_LLH_LEN); ++ } else { ++ iov[0].iov_base = uip_buf; ++ iov[0].iov_len = 40 + UIP_LLH_LEN; ++ iov[1].iov_base = (char *)uip_appdata; ++ iov[1].iov_len = uip_len - (40 + UIP_LLH_LEN); ++ ++ ret = writev(fd, iov, 2); ++ } ++#endif ++ dump_mem(1, ret); ++ ++ if(ret == -1) { ++ perror("tap_dev: tapdev_send: writev"); ++ exit(1); ++ } ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/tapdev.h +@@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001, Adam Dunkels. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote ++ * products derived from this software without specific prior ++ * written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS ++ * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED ++ * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY ++ * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE ++ * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS ++ * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ++ * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING ++ * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS ++ * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * ++ * $Id: tapdev.h,v 1.1.2.1 2003/10/04 22:54:17 adam Exp $ ++ * ++ */ ++ ++#ifndef __TAPDEV_H__ ++#define __TAPDEV_H__ ++ ++void tapdev_init(void); ++unsigned int tapdev_read(void); ++void tapdev_send(void); ++ ++#endif /* __TAPDEV_H__ */ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/uip_arch.c +@@ -0,0 +1,145 @@ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001, Adam Dunkels. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote ++ * products derived from this software without specific prior ++ * written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS ++ * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED ++ * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY ++ * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE ++ * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS ++ * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ++ * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING ++ * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS ++ * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * ++ * $Id: uip_arch.c,v 1.2.2.1 2003/10/04 22:54:17 adam Exp $ ++ * ++ */ ++ ++ ++#include "uip.h" ++#include "uip_arch.h" ++ ++#define BUF ((uip_tcpip_hdr *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN]) ++#define IP_PROTO_TCP 6 ++ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++void ++uip_add32(u8_t *op32, u16_t op16) ++{ ++ ++ uip_acc32[3] = op32[3] + (op16 & 0xff); ++ uip_acc32[2] = op32[2] + (op16 >> 8); ++ uip_acc32[1] = op32[1]; ++ uip_acc32[0] = op32[0]; ++ ++ if(uip_acc32[2] < (op16 >> 8)) { ++ ++uip_acc32[1]; ++ if(uip_acc32[1] == 0) { ++ ++uip_acc32[0]; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ ++ if(uip_acc32[3] < (op16 & 0xff)) { ++ ++uip_acc32[2]; ++ if(uip_acc32[2] == 0) { ++ ++uip_acc32[1]; ++ if(uip_acc32[1] == 0) { ++ ++uip_acc32[0]; ++ } ++ } ++ } ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++u16_t ++uip_chksum(u16_t *sdata, u16_t len) ++{ ++ u16_t acc; ++ ++ for(acc = 0; len > 1; len -= 2) { ++ acc += *sdata; ++ if(acc < *sdata) { ++ /* Overflow, so we add the carry to acc (i.e., increase by ++ one). */ ++ ++acc; ++ } ++ ++sdata; ++ } ++ ++ /* add up any odd byte */ ++ if(len == 1) { ++ acc += htons(((u16_t)(*(u8_t *)sdata)) << 8); ++ if(acc < htons(((u16_t)(*(u8_t *)sdata)) << 8)) { ++ ++acc; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ return acc; ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++u16_t ++uip_ipchksum(void) ++{ ++ return uip_chksum((u16_t *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN], 20); ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++u16_t ++uip_tcpchksum(void) ++{ ++ u16_t hsum, sum; ++ ++ ++ /* Compute the checksum of the TCP header. */ ++ hsum = uip_chksum((u16_t *)&uip_buf[20 + UIP_LLH_LEN], 20); ++ ++ /* Compute the checksum of the data in the TCP packet and add it to ++ the TCP header checksum. */ ++ sum = uip_chksum((u16_t *)uip_appdata, ++ (u16_t)(((((u16_t)(BUF->len[0]) << 8) + BUF->len[1]) - 40))); ++ ++ if((sum += hsum) < hsum) { ++ ++sum; ++ } ++ ++ if((sum += BUF->srcipaddr[0]) < BUF->srcipaddr[0]) { ++ ++sum; ++ } ++ if((sum += BUF->srcipaddr[1]) < BUF->srcipaddr[1]) { ++ ++sum; ++ } ++ if((sum += BUF->destipaddr[0]) < BUF->destipaddr[0]) { ++ ++sum; ++ } ++ if((sum += BUF->destipaddr[1]) < BUF->destipaddr[1]) { ++ ++sum; ++ } ++ if((sum += (u16_t)htons((u16_t)IP_PROTO_TCP)) < (u16_t)htons((u16_t)IP_PROTO_TCP)) { ++ ++sum; ++ } ++ ++ hsum = (u16_t)htons((((u16_t)(BUF->len[0]) << 8) + BUF->len[1]) - 20); ++ ++ if((sum += hsum) < hsum) { ++ ++sum; ++ } ++ ++ return sum; ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/uip_arch.h +@@ -0,0 +1,130 @@ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uiparch Architecture specific uIP functions ++ * @{ ++ * ++ * The functions in the architecture specific module implement the IP ++ * check sum and 32-bit additions. ++ * ++ * The IP checksum calculation is the most computationally expensive ++ * operation in the TCP/IP stack and it therefore pays off to ++ * implement this in efficient assembler. The purpose of the uip-arch ++ * module is to let the checksum functions to be implemented in ++ * architecture specific assembler. ++ * ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \file ++ * Declarations of architecture specific functions. ++ * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> ++ */ ++ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001, Adam Dunkels. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote ++ * products derived from this software without specific prior ++ * written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS ++ * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED ++ * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY ++ * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE ++ * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS ++ * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ++ * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING ++ * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS ++ * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * ++ * $Id: uip_arch.h,v 1.1.2.2 2003/10/06 15:10:22 adam Exp $ ++ * ++ */ ++ ++#ifndef __UIP_ARCH_H__ ++#define __UIP_ARCH_H__ ++ ++#include "uip.h" ++ ++/** ++ * Carry out a 32-bit addition. ++ * ++ * Because not all architectures for which uIP is intended has native ++ * 32-bit arithmetic, uIP uses an external C function for doing the ++ * required 32-bit additions in the TCP protocol processing. This ++ * function should add the two arguments and place the result in the ++ * global variable uip_acc32. ++ * ++ * \note The 32-bit integer pointed to by the op32 parameter and the ++ * result in the uip_acc32 variable are in network byte order (big ++ * endian). ++ * ++ * \param op32 A pointer to a 4-byte array representing a 32-bit ++ * integer in network byte order (big endian). ++ * ++ * \param op16 A 16-bit integer in host byte order. ++ */ ++void uip_add32(u8_t *op32, u16_t op16); ++ ++/** ++ * Calculate the Internet checksum over a buffer. ++ * ++ * The Internet checksum is the one's complement of the one's ++ * complement sum of all 16-bit words in the buffer. ++ * ++ * See RFC1071. ++ * ++ * \note This function is not called in the current version of uIP, ++ * but future versions might make use of it. ++ * ++ * \param buf A pointer to the buffer over which the checksum is to be ++ * computed. ++ * ++ * \param len The length of the buffer over which the checksum is to ++ * be computed. ++ * ++ * \return The Internet checksum of the buffer. ++ */ ++u16_t uip_chksum(u16_t *buf, u16_t len); ++ ++/** ++ * Calculate the IP header checksum of the packet header in uip_buf. ++ * ++ * The IP header checksum is the Internet checksum of the 20 bytes of ++ * the IP header. ++ * ++ * \return The IP header checksum of the IP header in the uip_buf ++ * buffer. ++ */ ++u16_t uip_ipchksum(void); ++ ++/** ++ * Calculate the TCP checksum of the packet in uip_buf and uip_appdata. ++ * ++ * The TCP checksum is the Internet checksum of data contents of the ++ * TCP segment, and a pseudo-header as defined in RFC793. ++ * ++ * \note The uip_appdata pointer that points to the packet data may ++ * point anywhere in memory, so it is not possible to simply calculate ++ * the Internet checksum of the contents of the uip_buf buffer. ++ * ++ * \return The TCP checksum of the TCP segment in uip_buf and pointed ++ * to by uip_appdata. ++ */ ++u16_t uip_tcpchksum(void); ++ ++/** @} */ ++ ++#endif /* __UIP_ARCH_H__ */ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/uip_arp.c +@@ -0,0 +1,421 @@ ++/** ++ * \addtogroup uip ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uiparp uIP Address Resolution Protocol ++ * @{ ++ * ++ * The Address Resolution Protocol ARP is used for mapping between IP ++ * addresses and link level addresses such as the Ethernet MAC ++ * addresses. ARP uses broadcast queries to ask for the link level ++ * address of a known IP address and the host which is configured with ++ * the IP address for which the query was meant, will respond with its ++ * link level address. ++ * ++ * \note This ARP implementation only supports Ethernet. ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \file ++ * Implementation of the ARP Address Resolution Protocol. ++ * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> ++ * ++ */ ++ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote ++ * products derived from this software without specific prior ++ * written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS ++ * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED ++ * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY ++ * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE ++ * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS ++ * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ++ * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING ++ * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS ++ * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * ++ * $Id: uip_arp.c,v 1.7.2.3 2003/10/06 22:42:30 adam Exp $ ++ * ++ */ ++ ++ ++#include "uip_arp.h" ++ ++struct arp_hdr { ++ struct uip_eth_hdr ethhdr; ++ u16_t hwtype; ++ u16_t protocol; ++ u8_t hwlen; ++ u8_t protolen; ++ u16_t opcode; ++ struct uip_eth_addr shwaddr; ++ u16_t sipaddr[2]; ++ struct uip_eth_addr dhwaddr; ++ u16_t dipaddr[2]; ++}; ++ ++struct ethip_hdr { ++ struct uip_eth_hdr ethhdr; ++ /* IP header. */ ++ u8_t vhl, ++ tos, ++ len[2], ++ ipid[2], ++ ipoffset[2], ++ ttl, ++ proto; ++ u16_t ipchksum; ++ u16_t srcipaddr[2], ++ destipaddr[2]; ++}; ++ ++#define ARP_REQUEST 1 ++#define ARP_REPLY 2 ++ ++#define ARP_HWTYPE_ETH 1 ++ ++struct arp_entry { ++ u16_t ipaddr[2]; ++ struct uip_eth_addr ethaddr; ++ u8_t time; ++}; ++ ++struct uip_eth_addr uip_ethaddr = {{UIP_ETHADDR0, ++ UIP_ETHADDR1, ++ UIP_ETHADDR2, ++ UIP_ETHADDR3, ++ UIP_ETHADDR4, ++ UIP_ETHADDR5}}; ++ ++static struct arp_entry arp_table[UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE]; ++static u16_t ipaddr[2]; ++static u8_t i, c; ++ ++static u8_t arptime; ++static u8_t tmpage; ++ ++#define BUF ((struct arp_hdr *)&uip_buf[0]) ++#define IPBUF ((struct ethip_hdr *)&uip_buf[0]) ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/** ++ * Initialize the ARP module. ++ * ++ */ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++void ++uip_arp_init(void) ++{ ++ for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { ++ memset(arp_table[i].ipaddr, 0, 4); ++ } ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/** ++ * Periodic ARP processing function. ++ * ++ * This function performs periodic timer processing in the ARP module ++ * and should be called at regular intervals. The recommended interval ++ * is 10 seconds between the calls. ++ * ++ */ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++void ++uip_arp_timer(void) ++{ ++ struct arp_entry *tabptr; ++ ++ ++arptime; ++ for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { ++ tabptr = &arp_table[i]; ++ if((tabptr->ipaddr[0] | tabptr->ipaddr[1]) != 0 && ++ arptime - tabptr->time >= UIP_ARP_MAXAGE) { ++ memset(tabptr->ipaddr, 0, 4); ++ } ++ } ++ ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++static void ++uip_arp_update(u16_t *ipaddr, struct uip_eth_addr *ethaddr) ++{ ++ register struct arp_entry *tabptr; ++ /* Walk through the ARP mapping table and try to find an entry to ++ update. If none is found, the IP -> MAC address mapping is ++ inserted in the ARP table. */ ++ for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { ++ ++ tabptr = &arp_table[i]; ++ /* Only check those entries that are actually in use. */ ++ if(tabptr->ipaddr[0] != 0 && ++ tabptr->ipaddr[1] != 0) { ++ ++ /* Check if the source IP address of the incoming packet matches ++ the IP address in this ARP table entry. */ ++ if(ipaddr[0] == tabptr->ipaddr[0] && ++ ipaddr[1] == tabptr->ipaddr[1]) { ++ ++ /* An old entry found, update this and return. */ ++ memcpy(tabptr->ethaddr.addr, ethaddr->addr, 6); ++ tabptr->time = arptime; ++ ++ return; ++ } ++ } ++ } ++ ++ /* If we get here, no existing ARP table entry was found, so we ++ create one. */ ++ ++ /* First, we try to find an unused entry in the ARP table. */ ++ for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { ++ tabptr = &arp_table[i]; ++ if(tabptr->ipaddr[0] == 0 && ++ tabptr->ipaddr[1] == 0) { ++ break; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ /* If no unused entry is found, we try to find the oldest entry and ++ throw it away. */ ++ if(i == UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE) { ++ tmpage = 0; ++ c = 0; ++ for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { ++ tabptr = &arp_table[i]; ++ if(arptime - tabptr->time > tmpage) { ++ tmpage = arptime - tabptr->time; ++ c = i; ++ } ++ } ++ i = c; ++ } ++ ++ /* Now, i is the ARP table entry which we will fill with the new ++ information. */ ++ memcpy(tabptr->ipaddr, ipaddr, 4); ++ memcpy(tabptr->ethaddr.addr, ethaddr->addr, 6); ++ tabptr->time = arptime; ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/** ++ * ARP processing for incoming IP packets ++ * ++ * This function should be called by the device driver when an IP ++ * packet has been received. The function will check if the address is ++ * in the ARP cache, and if so the ARP cache entry will be ++ * refreshed. If no ARP cache entry was found, a new one is created. ++ * ++ * This function expects an IP packet with a prepended Ethernet header ++ * in the uip_buf[] buffer, and the length of the packet in the global ++ * variable uip_len. ++ */ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++void ++uip_arp_ipin(void) ++{ ++ uip_len -= sizeof(struct uip_eth_hdr); ++ ++ /* Only insert/update an entry if the source IP address of the ++ incoming IP packet comes from a host on the local network. */ ++ if((IPBUF->srcipaddr[0] & uip_arp_netmask[0]) != ++ (uip_hostaddr[0] & uip_arp_netmask[0])) { ++ return; ++ } ++ if((IPBUF->srcipaddr[1] & uip_arp_netmask[1]) != ++ (uip_hostaddr[1] & uip_arp_netmask[1])) { ++ return; ++ } ++ uip_arp_update(IPBUF->srcipaddr, &(IPBUF->ethhdr.src)); ++ ++ return; ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/** ++ * ARP processing for incoming ARP packets. ++ * ++ * This function should be called by the device driver when an ARP ++ * packet has been received. The function will act differently ++ * depending on the ARP packet type: if it is a reply for a request ++ * that we previously sent out, the ARP cache will be filled in with ++ * the values from the ARP reply. If the incoming ARP packet is an ARP ++ * request for our IP address, an ARP reply packet is created and put ++ * into the uip_buf[] buffer. ++ * ++ * When the function returns, the value of the global variable uip_len ++ * indicates whether the device driver should send out a packet or ++ * not. If uip_len is zero, no packet should be sent. If uip_len is ++ * non-zero, it contains the length of the outbound packet that is ++ * present in the uip_buf[] buffer. ++ * ++ * This function expects an ARP packet with a prepended Ethernet ++ * header in the uip_buf[] buffer, and the length of the packet in the ++ * global variable uip_len. ++ */ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++void ++uip_arp_arpin(void) ++{ ++ ++ if(uip_len < sizeof(struct arp_hdr)) { ++ uip_len = 0; ++ return; ++ } ++ ++ uip_len = 0; ++ ++ switch(BUF->opcode) { ++ case HTONS(ARP_REQUEST): ++ /* ARP request. If it asked for our address, we send out a ++ reply. */ ++ if(BUF->dipaddr[0] == uip_hostaddr[0] && ++ BUF->dipaddr[1] == uip_hostaddr[1]) { ++ /* The reply opcode is 2. */ ++ BUF->opcode = HTONS(2); ++ ++ memcpy(BUF->dhwaddr.addr, BUF->shwaddr.addr, 6); ++ memcpy(BUF->shwaddr.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); ++ memcpy(BUF->ethhdr.src.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); ++ memcpy(BUF->ethhdr.dest.addr, BUF->dhwaddr.addr, 6); ++ ++ BUF->dipaddr[0] = BUF->sipaddr[0]; ++ BUF->dipaddr[1] = BUF->sipaddr[1]; ++ BUF->sipaddr[0] = uip_hostaddr[0]; ++ BUF->sipaddr[1] = uip_hostaddr[1]; ++ ++ BUF->ethhdr.type = HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP); ++ uip_len = sizeof(struct arp_hdr); ++ } ++ break; ++ case HTONS(ARP_REPLY): ++ /* ARP reply. We insert or update the ARP table if it was meant ++ for us. */ ++ if(BUF->dipaddr[0] == uip_hostaddr[0] && ++ BUF->dipaddr[1] == uip_hostaddr[1]) { ++ ++ uip_arp_update(BUF->sipaddr, &BUF->shwaddr); ++ } ++ break; ++ } ++ ++ return; ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/** ++ * Prepend Ethernet header to an outbound IP packet and see if we need ++ * to send out an ARP request. ++ * ++ * This function should be called before sending out an IP packet. The ++ * function checks the destination IP address of the IP packet to see ++ * what Ethernet MAC address that should be used as a destination MAC ++ * address on the Ethernet. ++ * ++ * If the destination IP address is in the local network (determined ++ * by logical ANDing of netmask and our IP address), the function ++ * checks the ARP cache to see if an entry for the destination IP ++ * address is found. If so, an Ethernet header is prepended and the ++ * function returns. If no ARP cache entry is found for the ++ * destination IP address, the packet in the uip_buf[] is replaced by ++ * an ARP request packet for the IP address. The IP packet is dropped ++ * and it is assumed that they higher level protocols (e.g., TCP) ++ * eventually will retransmit the dropped packet. ++ * ++ * If the destination IP address is not on the local network, the IP ++ * address of the default router is used instead. ++ * ++ * When the function returns, a packet is present in the uip_buf[] ++ * buffer, and the length of the packet is in the global variable ++ * uip_len. ++ */ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++void ++uip_arp_out(void) ++{ ++ struct arp_entry *tabptr; ++ /* Find the destination IP address in the ARP table and construct ++ the Ethernet header. If the destination IP addres isn't on the ++ local network, we use the default router's IP address instead. ++ ++ If not ARP table entry is found, we overwrite the original IP ++ packet with an ARP request for the IP address. */ ++ ++ /* Check if the destination address is on the local network. */ ++ if((IPBUF->destipaddr[0] & uip_arp_netmask[0]) != ++ (uip_hostaddr[0] & uip_arp_netmask[0]) || ++ (IPBUF->destipaddr[1] & uip_arp_netmask[1]) != ++ (uip_hostaddr[1] & uip_arp_netmask[1])) { ++ /* Destination address was not on the local network, so we need to ++ use the default router's IP address instead of the destination ++ address when determining the MAC address. */ ++ ipaddr[0] = uip_arp_draddr[0]; ++ ipaddr[1] = uip_arp_draddr[1]; ++ } else { ++ /* Else, we use the destination IP address. */ ++ ipaddr[0] = IPBUF->destipaddr[0]; ++ ipaddr[1] = IPBUF->destipaddr[1]; ++ } ++ ++ for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { ++ tabptr = &arp_table[i]; ++ if(ipaddr[0] == tabptr->ipaddr[0] && ++ ipaddr[1] == tabptr->ipaddr[1]) ++ break; ++ } ++ ++ if(i == UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE) { ++ /* The destination address was not in our ARP table, so we ++ overwrite the IP packet with an ARP request. */ ++ ++ memset(BUF->ethhdr.dest.addr, 0xff, 6); ++ memset(BUF->dhwaddr.addr, 0x00, 6); ++ memcpy(BUF->ethhdr.src.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); ++ memcpy(BUF->shwaddr.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); ++ ++ BUF->dipaddr[0] = ipaddr[0]; ++ BUF->dipaddr[1] = ipaddr[1]; ++ BUF->sipaddr[0] = uip_hostaddr[0]; ++ BUF->sipaddr[1] = uip_hostaddr[1]; ++ BUF->opcode = HTONS(ARP_REQUEST); /* ARP request. */ ++ BUF->hwtype = HTONS(ARP_HWTYPE_ETH); ++ BUF->protocol = HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_IP); ++ BUF->hwlen = 6; ++ BUF->protolen = 4; ++ BUF->ethhdr.type = HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP); ++ ++ uip_appdata = &uip_buf[40 + UIP_LLH_LEN]; ++ ++ uip_len = sizeof(struct arp_hdr); ++ return; ++ } ++ ++ /* Build an ethernet header. */ ++ memcpy(IPBUF->ethhdr.dest.addr, tabptr->ethaddr.addr, 6); ++ memcpy(IPBUF->ethhdr.src.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); ++ ++ IPBUF->ethhdr.type = HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_IP); ++ ++ uip_len += sizeof(struct uip_eth_hdr); ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++ ++/** @} */ ++/** @} */ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/uip_arp.h +@@ -0,0 +1,201 @@ ++/** ++ * \addtogroup uip ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \addtogroup uiparp ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \file ++ * Macros and definitions for the ARP module. ++ * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> ++ */ ++ ++ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote ++ * products derived from this software without specific prior ++ * written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS ++ * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED ++ * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY ++ * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE ++ * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS ++ * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ++ * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING ++ * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS ++ * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * ++ * $Id: uip_arp.h,v 1.3.2.2 2003/10/06 15:10:22 adam Exp $ ++ * ++ */ ++ ++#ifndef __UIP_ARP_H__ ++#define __UIP_ARP_H__ ++ ++#include "uip.h" ++ ++ ++/** ++ * Representation of a 48-bit Ethernet address. ++ */ ++struct uip_eth_addr { ++ u8_t addr[6]; ++}; ++ ++extern struct uip_eth_addr uip_ethaddr; ++ ++/** ++ * The Ethernet header. ++ */ ++struct uip_eth_hdr { ++ struct uip_eth_addr dest; ++ struct uip_eth_addr src; ++ u16_t type; ++}; ++ ++#define UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP 0x0806 ++#define UIP_ETHTYPE_IP 0x0800 ++#define UIP_ETHTYPE_IP6 0x86dd ++ ++ ++/* The uip_arp_init() function must be called before any of the other ++ ARP functions. */ ++void uip_arp_init(void); ++ ++/* The uip_arp_ipin() function should be called whenever an IP packet ++ arrives from the Ethernet. This function refreshes the ARP table or ++ inserts a new mapping if none exists. The function assumes that an ++ IP packet with an Ethernet header is present in the uip_buf buffer ++ and that the length of the packet is in the uip_len variable. */ ++void uip_arp_ipin(void); ++ ++/* The uip_arp_arpin() should be called when an ARP packet is received ++ by the Ethernet driver. This function also assumes that the ++ Ethernet frame is present in the uip_buf buffer. When the ++ uip_arp_arpin() function returns, the contents of the uip_buf ++ buffer should be sent out on the Ethernet if the uip_len variable ++ is > 0. */ ++void uip_arp_arpin(void); ++ ++/* The uip_arp_out() function should be called when an IP packet ++ should be sent out on the Ethernet. This function creates an ++ Ethernet header before the IP header in the uip_buf buffer. The ++ Ethernet header will have the correct Ethernet MAC destination ++ address filled in if an ARP table entry for the destination IP ++ address (or the IP address of the default router) is present. If no ++ such table entry is found, the IP packet is overwritten with an ARP ++ request and we rely on TCP to retransmit the packet that was ++ overwritten. In any case, the uip_len variable holds the length of ++ the Ethernet frame that should be transmitted. */ ++void uip_arp_out(void); ++ ++/* The uip_arp_timer() function should be called every ten seconds. It ++ is responsible for flushing old entries in the ARP table. */ ++void uip_arp_timer(void); ++ ++/** @} */ ++ ++/** ++ * \addtogroup uipconffunc ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * Set the default router's IP address. ++ * ++ * \param addr A pointer to a 4-byte array containing the IP address ++ * of the default router. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_setdraddr(addr) do { uip_arp_draddr[0] = addr[0]; \ ++ uip_arp_draddr[1] = addr[1]; } while(0) ++ ++/** ++ * Set the netmask. ++ * ++ * \param addr A pointer to a 4-byte array containing the IP address ++ * of the netmask. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_setnetmask(addr) do { uip_arp_netmask[0] = addr[0]; \ ++ uip_arp_netmask[1] = addr[1]; } while(0) ++ ++ ++/** ++ * Get the default router's IP address. ++ * ++ * \param addr A pointer to a 4-byte array that will be filled in with ++ * the IP address of the default router. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_getdraddr(addr) do { addr[0] = uip_arp_draddr[0]; \ ++ addr[1] = uip_arp_draddr[1]; } while(0) ++ ++/** ++ * Get the netmask. ++ * ++ * \param addr A pointer to a 4-byte array that will be filled in with ++ * the value of the netmask. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_getnetmask(addr) do { addr[0] = uip_arp_netmask[0]; \ ++ addr[1] = uip_arp_netmask[1]; } while(0) ++ ++ ++/** ++ * Specifiy the Ethernet MAC address. ++ * ++ * The ARP code needs to know the MAC address of the Ethernet card in ++ * order to be able to respond to ARP queries and to generate working ++ * Ethernet headers. ++ * ++ * \note This macro only specifies the Ethernet MAC address to the ARP ++ * code. It cannot be used to change the MAC address of the Ethernet ++ * card. ++ * ++ * \param eaddr A pointer to a struct uip_eth_addr containing the ++ * Ethernet MAC address of the Ethernet card. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_setethaddr(eaddr) do {uip_ethaddr.addr[0] = eaddr.addr[0]; \ ++ uip_ethaddr.addr[1] = eaddr.addr[1];\ ++ uip_ethaddr.addr[2] = eaddr.addr[2];\ ++ uip_ethaddr.addr[3] = eaddr.addr[3];\ ++ uip_ethaddr.addr[4] = eaddr.addr[4];\ ++ uip_ethaddr.addr[5] = eaddr.addr[5];} while(0) ++ ++/** @} */ ++ ++/** ++ * \internal Internal variables that are set using the macros ++ * uip_setdraddr and uip_setnetmask. ++ */ ++extern u16_t uip_arp_draddr[2], uip_arp_netmask[2]; ++#endif /* __UIP_ARP_H__ */ ++ ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/uip.c +@@ -0,0 +1,1503 @@ ++/** ++ * \addtogroup uip ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \file ++ * The uIP TCP/IP stack code. ++ * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> ++ */ ++ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote ++ * products derived from this software without specific prior ++ * written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS ++ * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED ++ * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY ++ * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE ++ * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS ++ * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ++ * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING ++ * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS ++ * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * ++ * $Id: uip.c,v 1.62.2.10 2003/10/07 13:23:01 adam Exp $ ++ * ++ */ ++ ++/* ++This is a small implementation of the IP and TCP protocols (as well as ++some basic ICMP stuff). The implementation couples the IP, TCP and the ++application layers very tightly. To keep the size of the compiled code ++down, this code also features heavy usage of the goto statement. ++ ++The principle is that we have a small buffer, called the uip_buf, in ++which the device driver puts an incoming packet. The TCP/IP stack ++parses the headers in the packet, and calls upon the application. If ++the remote host has sent data to the application, this data is present ++in the uip_buf and the application read the data from there. It is up ++to the application to put this data into a byte stream if needed. The ++application will not be fed with data that is out of sequence. ++ ++If the application whishes to send data to the peer, it should put its ++data into the uip_buf, 40 bytes from the start of the buffer. The ++TCP/IP stack will calculate the checksums, and fill in the necessary ++header fields and finally send the packet back to the peer. ++*/ ++ ++#include "uip.h" ++#include "uipopt.h" ++#include "uip_arch.h" ++ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/* Variable definitions. */ ++ ++ ++/* The IP address of this host. If it is defined to be fixed (by setting UIP_FIXEDADDR to 1 in uipopt.h), the address is set here. Otherwise, the address */ ++#if UIP_FIXEDADDR > 0 ++const unsigned short int uip_hostaddr[2] = ++ {HTONS((UIP_IPADDR0 << 8) | UIP_IPADDR1), ++ HTONS((UIP_IPADDR2 << 8) | UIP_IPADDR3)}; ++const unsigned short int uip_arp_draddr[2] = ++ {HTONS((UIP_DRIPADDR0 << 8) | UIP_DRIPADDR1), ++ HTONS((UIP_DRIPADDR2 << 8) | UIP_DRIPADDR3)}; ++const unsigned short int uip_arp_netmask[2] = ++ {HTONS((UIP_NETMASK0 << 8) | UIP_NETMASK1), ++ HTONS((UIP_NETMASK2 << 8) | UIP_NETMASK3)}; ++#else ++unsigned short int uip_hostaddr[2]; ++unsigned short int uip_arp_draddr[2], uip_arp_netmask[2]; ++#endif /* UIP_FIXEDADDR */ ++ ++u8_t uip_buf[UIP_BUFSIZE+2]; /* The packet buffer that contains ++ incoming packets. */ ++volatile u8_t *uip_appdata; /* The uip_appdata pointer points to ++ application data. */ ++volatile u8_t *uip_sappdata; /* The uip_appdata pointer points to the ++ application data which is to be sent. */ ++#if UIP_URGDATA > 0 ++volatile u8_t *uip_urgdata; /* The uip_urgdata pointer points to ++ urgent data (out-of-band data), if ++ present. */ ++volatile u8_t uip_urglen, uip_surglen; ++#endif /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ ++ ++volatile unsigned short int uip_len, uip_slen; ++ /* The uip_len is either 8 or 16 bits, ++ depending on the maximum packet ++ size. */ ++ ++volatile u8_t uip_flags; /* The uip_flags variable is used for ++ communication between the TCP/IP stack ++ and the application program. */ ++struct uip_conn *uip_conn; /* uip_conn always points to the current ++ connection. */ ++ ++struct uip_conn uip_conns[UIP_CONNS]; ++ /* The uip_conns array holds all TCP ++ connections. */ ++unsigned short int uip_listenports[UIP_LISTENPORTS]; ++ /* The uip_listenports list all currently ++ listning ports. */ ++#if UIP_UDP ++struct uip_udp_conn *uip_udp_conn; ++struct uip_udp_conn uip_udp_conns[UIP_UDP_CONNS]; ++#endif /* UIP_UDP */ ++ ++ ++static unsigned short int ipid; /* Ths ipid variable is an increasing ++ number that is used for the IP ID ++ field. */ ++ ++static u8_t iss[4]; /* The iss variable is used for the TCP ++ initial sequence number. */ ++ ++#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN ++static unsigned short int lastport; /* Keeps track of the last port used for ++ a new connection. */ ++#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ ++ ++/* Temporary variables. */ ++volatile u8_t uip_acc32[4]; ++static u8_t c, opt; ++static unsigned short int tmp16; ++ ++/* Structures and definitions. */ ++#define TCP_FIN 0x01 ++#define TCP_SYN 0x02 ++#define TCP_RST 0x04 ++#define TCP_PSH 0x08 ++#define TCP_ACK 0x10 ++#define TCP_URG 0x20 ++#define TCP_CTL 0x3f ++ ++#define ICMP_ECHO_REPLY 0 ++#define ICMP_ECHO 8 ++ ++/* Macros. */ ++#define BUF ((uip_tcpip_hdr *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN]) ++#define FBUF ((uip_tcpip_hdr *)&uip_reassbuf[0]) ++#define ICMPBUF ((uip_icmpip_hdr *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN]) ++#define UDPBUF ((uip_udpip_hdr *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN]) ++ ++#if UIP_STATISTICS == 1 ++struct uip_stats uip_stat; ++#define UIP_STAT(s) s ++#else ++#define UIP_STAT(s) ++#endif /* UIP_STATISTICS == 1 */ ++ ++#if UIP_LOGGING == 1 ++extern void puts(const char *s); ++#define UIP_LOG(m) puts(m) ++#else ++#define UIP_LOG(m) ++#endif /* UIP_LOGGING == 1 */ ++ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++void ++uip_init(void) ++{ ++ for(c = 0; c < UIP_LISTENPORTS; ++c) { ++ uip_listenports[c] = 0; ++ } ++ for(c = 0; c < UIP_CONNS; ++c) { ++ uip_conns[c].tcpstateflags = CLOSED; ++ } ++#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN ++ lastport = 1024; ++#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ ++ ++#if UIP_UDP ++ for(c = 0; c < UIP_UDP_CONNS; ++c) { ++ uip_udp_conns[c].lport = 0; ++ } ++#endif /* UIP_UDP */ ++ ++ ++ /* IPv4 initialization. */ ++#if UIP_FIXEDADDR == 0 ++ uip_hostaddr[0] = uip_hostaddr[1] = 0; ++#endif /* UIP_FIXEDADDR */ ++ ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN ++struct uip_conn * ++uip_connect(unsigned short int *ripaddr, unsigned short int rport) ++{ ++ register struct uip_conn *conn, *cconn; ++ ++ /* Find an unused local port. */ ++ again: ++ ++lastport; ++ ++ if(lastport >= 32000) { ++ lastport = 4096; ++ } ++ ++ /* Check if this port is already in use, and if so try to find ++ another one. */ ++ for(c = 0; c < UIP_CONNS; ++c) { ++ conn = &uip_conns[c]; ++ if(conn->tcpstateflags != CLOSED && ++ conn->lport == htons(lastport)) { ++ goto again; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ ++ conn = 0; ++ for(c = 0; c < UIP_CONNS; ++c) { ++ cconn = &uip_conns[c]; ++ if(cconn->tcpstateflags == CLOSED) { ++ conn = cconn; ++ break; ++ } ++ if(cconn->tcpstateflags == TIME_WAIT) { ++ if(conn == 0 || ++ cconn->timer > uip_conn->timer) { ++ conn = cconn; ++ } ++ } ++ } ++ ++ if(conn == 0) { ++ return 0; ++ } ++ ++ conn->tcpstateflags = SYN_SENT; ++ ++ conn->snd_nxt[0] = iss[0]; ++ conn->snd_nxt[1] = iss[1]; ++ conn->snd_nxt[2] = iss[2]; ++ conn->snd_nxt[3] = iss[3]; ++ ++ conn->initialmss = conn->mss = UIP_TCP_MSS; ++ ++ conn->len = 1; /* TCP length of the SYN is one. */ ++ conn->nrtx = 0; ++ conn->timer = 1; /* Send the SYN next time around. */ ++ conn->rto = UIP_RTO; ++ conn->sa = 0; ++ conn->sv = 16; ++ conn->lport = htons(lastport); ++ conn->rport = rport; ++ conn->ripaddr[0] = ripaddr[0]; ++ conn->ripaddr[1] = ripaddr[1]; ++ ++ return conn; ++} ++#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++#if UIP_UDP ++struct uip_udp_conn * ++uip_udp_new(unsigned short int *ripaddr, unsigned short int rport) ++{ ++ register struct uip_udp_conn *conn; ++ ++ /* Find an unused local port. */ ++ again: ++ ++lastport; ++ ++ if(lastport >= 32000) { ++ lastport = 4096; ++ } ++ ++ for(c = 0; c < UIP_UDP_CONNS; ++c) { ++ if(uip_udp_conns[c].lport == lastport) { ++ goto again; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ ++ conn = 0; ++ for(c = 0; c < UIP_UDP_CONNS; ++c) { ++ if(uip_udp_conns[c].lport == 0) { ++ conn = &uip_udp_conns[c]; ++ break; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ if(conn == 0) { ++ return 0; ++ } ++ ++ conn->lport = HTONS(lastport); ++ conn->rport = HTONS(rport); ++ conn->ripaddr[0] = ripaddr[0]; ++ conn->ripaddr[1] = ripaddr[1]; ++ ++ return conn; ++} ++#endif /* UIP_UDP */ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++void ++uip_unlisten(unsigned short int port) ++{ ++ for(c = 0; c < UIP_LISTENPORTS; ++c) { ++ if(uip_listenports[c] == port) { ++ uip_listenports[c] = 0; ++ return; ++ } ++ } ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++void ++uip_listen(unsigned short int port) ++{ ++ for(c = 0; c < UIP_LISTENPORTS; ++c) { ++ if(uip_listenports[c] == 0) { ++ uip_listenports[c] = port; ++ return; ++ } ++ } ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/* XXX: IP fragment reassembly: not well-tested. */ ++ ++#if UIP_REASSEMBLY ++#define UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE (UIP_BUFSIZE - UIP_LLH_LEN) ++static u8_t uip_reassbuf[UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE]; ++static u8_t uip_reassbitmap[UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE / (8 * 8)]; ++static const u8_t bitmap_bits[8] = {0xff, 0x7f, 0x3f, 0x1f, ++ 0x0f, 0x07, 0x03, 0x01}; ++static unsigned short int uip_reasslen; ++static u8_t uip_reassflags; ++#define UIP_REASS_FLAG_LASTFRAG 0x01 ++static u8_t uip_reasstmr; ++ ++#define IP_HLEN 20 ++#define IP_MF 0x20 ++ ++static u8_t ++uip_reass(void) ++{ ++ unsigned short int offset, len; ++ unsigned short int i; ++ ++ /* If ip_reasstmr is zero, no packet is present in the buffer, so we ++ write the IP header of the fragment into the reassembly ++ buffer. The timer is updated with the maximum age. */ ++ if(uip_reasstmr == 0) { ++ memcpy(uip_reassbuf, &BUF->vhl, IP_HLEN); ++ uip_reasstmr = UIP_REASS_MAXAGE; ++ uip_reassflags = 0; ++ /* Clear the bitmap. */ ++ memset(uip_reassbitmap, sizeof(uip_reassbitmap), 0); ++ } ++ ++ /* Check if the incoming fragment matches the one currently present ++ in the reasembly buffer. If so, we proceed with copying the ++ fragment into the buffer. */ ++ if(BUF->srcipaddr[0] == FBUF->srcipaddr[0] && ++ BUF->srcipaddr[1] == FBUF->srcipaddr[1] && ++ BUF->destipaddr[0] == FBUF->destipaddr[0] && ++ BUF->destipaddr[1] == FBUF->destipaddr[1] && ++ BUF->ipid[0] == FBUF->ipid[0] && ++ BUF->ipid[1] == FBUF->ipid[1]) { ++ ++ len = (BUF->len[0] << 8) + BUF->len[1] - (BUF->vhl & 0x0f) * 4; ++ offset = (((BUF->ipoffset[0] & 0x3f) << 8) + BUF->ipoffset[1]) * 8; ++ ++ /* If the offset or the offset + fragment length overflows the ++ reassembly buffer, we discard the entire packet. */ ++ if(offset > UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE || ++ offset + len > UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE) { ++ uip_reasstmr = 0; ++ goto nullreturn; ++ } ++ ++ /* Copy the fragment into the reassembly buffer, at the right ++ offset. */ ++ memcpy(&uip_reassbuf[IP_HLEN + offset], ++ (char *)BUF + (int)((BUF->vhl & 0x0f) * 4), ++ len); ++ ++ /* Update the bitmap. */ ++ if(offset / (8 * 8) == (offset + len) / (8 * 8)) { ++ /* If the two endpoints are in the same byte, we only update ++ that byte. */ ++ ++ uip_reassbitmap[offset / (8 * 8)] |= ++ bitmap_bits[(offset / 8 ) & 7] & ++ ~bitmap_bits[((offset + len) / 8 ) & 7]; ++ } else { ++ /* If the two endpoints are in different bytes, we update the ++ bytes in the endpoints and fill the stuff inbetween with ++ 0xff. */ ++ uip_reassbitmap[offset / (8 * 8)] |= ++ bitmap_bits[(offset / 8 ) & 7]; ++ for(i = 1 + offset / (8 * 8); i < (offset + len) / (8 * 8); ++i) { ++ uip_reassbitmap[i] = 0xff; ++ } ++ uip_reassbitmap[(offset + len) / (8 * 8)] |= ++ ~bitmap_bits[((offset + len) / 8 ) & 7]; ++ } ++ ++ /* If this fragment has the More Fragments flag set to zero, we ++ know that this is the last fragment, so we can calculate the ++ size of the entire packet. We also set the ++ IP_REASS_FLAG_LASTFRAG flag to indicate that we have received ++ the final fragment. */ ++ ++ if((BUF->ipoffset[0] & IP_MF) == 0) { ++ uip_reassflags |= UIP_REASS_FLAG_LASTFRAG; ++ uip_reasslen = offset + len; ++ } ++ ++ /* Finally, we check if we have a full packet in the buffer. We do ++ this by checking if we have the last fragment and if all bits ++ in the bitmap are set. */ ++ if(uip_reassflags & UIP_REASS_FLAG_LASTFRAG) { ++ /* Check all bytes up to and including all but the last byte in ++ the bitmap. */ ++ for(i = 0; i < uip_reasslen / (8 * 8) - 1; ++i) { ++ if(uip_reassbitmap[i] != 0xff) { ++ goto nullreturn; ++ } ++ } ++ /* Check the last byte in the bitmap. It should contain just the ++ right amount of bits. */ ++ if(uip_reassbitmap[uip_reasslen / (8 * 8)] != ++ (u8_t)~bitmap_bits[uip_reasslen / 8 & 7]) { ++ goto nullreturn; ++ } ++ ++ /* If we have come this far, we have a full packet in the ++ buffer, so we allocate a pbuf and copy the packet into it. We ++ also reset the timer. */ ++ uip_reasstmr = 0; ++ memcpy(BUF, FBUF, uip_reasslen); ++ ++ /* Pretend to be a "normal" (i.e., not fragmented) IP packet ++ from now on. */ ++ BUF->ipoffset[0] = BUF->ipoffset[1] = 0; ++ BUF->len[0] = uip_reasslen >> 8; ++ BUF->len[1] = uip_reasslen & 0xff; ++ BUF->ipchksum = 0; ++ BUF->ipchksum = ~(uip_ipchksum()); ++ ++ return uip_reasslen; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ nullreturn: ++ return 0; ++} ++#endif /* UIP_REASSEMBL */ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++static void ++uip_add_rcv_nxt(unsigned short int n) ++{ ++ uip_add32(uip_conn->rcv_nxt, n); ++ uip_conn->rcv_nxt[0] = uip_acc32[0]; ++ uip_conn->rcv_nxt[1] = uip_acc32[1]; ++ uip_conn->rcv_nxt[2] = uip_acc32[2]; ++ uip_conn->rcv_nxt[3] = uip_acc32[3]; ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++void ++uip_process(u8_t flag) ++{ ++ register struct uip_conn *uip_connr = uip_conn; ++ ++ uip_appdata = &uip_buf[40 + UIP_LLH_LEN]; ++ ++ ++ /* Check if we were invoked because of the perodic timer fireing. */ ++ if(flag == UIP_TIMER) { ++#if UIP_REASSEMBLY ++ if(uip_reasstmr != 0) { ++ --uip_reasstmr; ++ } ++#endif /* UIP_REASSEMBLY */ ++ /* Increase the initial sequence number. */ ++ if(++iss[3] == 0) { ++ if(++iss[2] == 0) { ++ if(++iss[1] == 0) { ++ ++iss[0]; ++ } ++ } ++ } ++ uip_len = 0; ++ if(uip_connr->tcpstateflags == TIME_WAIT || ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags == FIN_WAIT_2) { ++ ++(uip_connr->timer); ++ if(uip_connr->timer == UIP_TIME_WAIT_TIMEOUT) { ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = CLOSED; ++ } ++ } else if(uip_connr->tcpstateflags != CLOSED) { ++ /* If the connection has outstanding data, we increase the ++ connection's timer and see if it has reached the RTO value ++ in which case we retransmit. */ ++ if(uip_outstanding(uip_connr)) { ++ if(uip_connr->timer-- == 0) { ++ if(uip_connr->nrtx == UIP_MAXRTX || ++ ((uip_connr->tcpstateflags == SYN_SENT || ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags == SYN_RCVD) && ++ uip_connr->nrtx == UIP_MAXSYNRTX)) { ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = CLOSED; ++ ++ /* We call UIP_APPCALL() with uip_flags set to ++ UIP_TIMEDOUT to inform the application that the ++ connection has timed out. */ ++ uip_flags = UIP_TIMEDOUT; ++ UIP_APPCALL(); ++ ++ /* We also send a reset packet to the remote host. */ ++ BUF->flags = TCP_RST | TCP_ACK; ++ goto tcp_send_nodata; ++ } ++ ++ /* Exponential backoff. */ ++ uip_connr->timer = UIP_RTO << (uip_connr->nrtx > 4? ++ 4: ++ uip_connr->nrtx); ++ ++(uip_connr->nrtx); ++ ++ /* Ok, so we need to retransmit. We do this differently ++ depending on which state we are in. In ESTABLISHED, we ++ call upon the application so that it may prepare the ++ data for the retransmit. In SYN_RCVD, we resend the ++ SYNACK that we sent earlier and in LAST_ACK we have to ++ retransmit our FINACK. */ ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.rexmit); ++ switch(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & TS_MASK) { ++ case SYN_RCVD: ++ /* In the SYN_RCVD state, we should retransmit our ++ SYNACK. */ ++ goto tcp_send_synack; ++ ++#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN ++ case SYN_SENT: ++ /* In the SYN_SENT state, we retransmit out SYN. */ ++ BUF->flags = 0; ++ goto tcp_send_syn; ++#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ ++ ++ case ESTABLISHED: ++ /* In the ESTABLISHED state, we call upon the application ++ to do the actual retransmit after which we jump into ++ the code for sending out the packet (the apprexmit ++ label). */ ++ uip_len = 0; ++ uip_slen = 0; ++ uip_flags = UIP_REXMIT; ++ UIP_APPCALL(); ++ goto apprexmit; ++ ++ case FIN_WAIT_1: ++ case CLOSING: ++ case LAST_ACK: ++ /* In all these states we should retransmit a FINACK. */ ++ goto tcp_send_finack; ++ ++ } ++ } ++ } else if((uip_connr->tcpstateflags & TS_MASK) == ESTABLISHED) { ++ /* If there was no need for a retransmission, we poll the ++ application for new data. */ ++ uip_len = 0; ++ uip_slen = 0; ++ uip_flags = UIP_POLL; ++ UIP_APPCALL(); ++ goto appsend; ++ } ++ } ++ goto drop; ++ } ++#if UIP_UDP ++ if(flag == UIP_UDP_TIMER) { ++ if(uip_udp_conn->lport != 0) { ++ uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + 28]; ++ uip_len = uip_slen = 0; ++ uip_flags = UIP_POLL; ++ UIP_UDP_APPCALL(); ++ goto udp_send; ++ } else { ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ } ++#endif ++ ++ /* This is where the input processing starts. */ ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.recv); ++ ++ ++ /* Start of IPv4 input header processing code. */ ++ ++ /* Check validity of the IP header. */ ++ if(BUF->vhl != 0x45) { /* IP version and header length. */ ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.vhlerr); ++ UIP_LOG("ip: invalid version or header length."); ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ ++ /* Check the size of the packet. If the size reported to us in ++ uip_len doesn't match the size reported in the IP header, there ++ has been a transmission error and we drop the packet. */ ++ ++ if(BUF->len[0] != (uip_len >> 8)) { /* IP length, high byte. */ ++ uip_len = (uip_len & 0xff) | (BUF->len[0] << 8); ++ } ++ if(BUF->len[1] != (uip_len & 0xff)) { /* IP length, low byte. */ ++ uip_len = (uip_len & 0xff00) | BUF->len[1]; ++ } ++ ++ /* Check the fragment flag. */ ++ if((BUF->ipoffset[0] & 0x3f) != 0 || ++ BUF->ipoffset[1] != 0) { ++#if UIP_REASSEMBLY ++ uip_len = uip_reass(); ++ if(uip_len == 0) { ++ goto drop; ++ } ++#else ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.fragerr); ++ UIP_LOG("ip: fragment dropped."); ++ goto drop; ++#endif /* UIP_REASSEMBLY */ ++ } ++ ++ /* If we are configured to use ping IP address configuration and ++ hasn't been assigned an IP address yet, we accept all ICMP ++ packets. */ ++#if UIP_PINGADDRCONF ++ if((uip_hostaddr[0] | uip_hostaddr[1]) == 0) { ++ if(BUF->proto == UIP_PROTO_ICMP) { ++ UIP_LOG("ip: possible ping config packet received."); ++ goto icmp_input; ++ } else { ++ UIP_LOG("ip: packet dropped since no address assigned."); ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ } ++#endif /* UIP_PINGADDRCONF */ ++ ++ /* Check if the packet is destined for our IP address. */ ++ if(BUF->destipaddr[0] != uip_hostaddr[0]) { ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); ++ UIP_LOG("ip: packet not for us."); ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ if(BUF->destipaddr[1] != uip_hostaddr[1]) { ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); ++ UIP_LOG("ip: packet not for us."); ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ ++ if(uip_ipchksum() != 0xffff) { /* Compute and check the IP header ++ checksum. */ ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.chkerr); ++ UIP_LOG("ip: bad checksum."); ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ ++ if(BUF->proto == UIP_PROTO_TCP) /* Check for TCP packet. If so, jump ++ to the tcp_input label. */ ++ goto tcp_input; ++ ++#if UIP_UDP ++ if(BUF->proto == UIP_PROTO_UDP) ++ goto udp_input; ++#endif /* UIP_UDP */ ++ ++ if(BUF->proto != UIP_PROTO_ICMP) { /* We only allow ICMP packets from ++ here. */ ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.protoerr); ++ UIP_LOG("ip: neither tcp nor icmp."); ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ ++ //icmp_input: ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.recv); ++ ++ /* ICMP echo (i.e., ping) processing. This is simple, we only change ++ the ICMP type from ECHO to ECHO_REPLY and adjust the ICMP ++ checksum before we return the packet. */ ++ if(ICMPBUF->type != ICMP_ECHO) { ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.drop); ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.typeerr); ++ UIP_LOG("icmp: not icmp echo."); ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ ++ /* If we are configured to use ping IP address assignment, we use ++ the destination IP address of this ping packet and assign it to ++ ourself. */ ++#if UIP_PINGADDRCONF ++ if((uip_hostaddr[0] | uip_hostaddr[1]) == 0) { ++ uip_hostaddr[0] = BUF->destipaddr[0]; ++ uip_hostaddr[1] = BUF->destipaddr[1]; ++ } ++#endif /* UIP_PINGADDRCONF */ ++ ++ ICMPBUF->type = ICMP_ECHO_REPLY; ++ ++ if(ICMPBUF->icmpchksum >= HTONS(0xffff - (ICMP_ECHO << 8))) { ++ ICMPBUF->icmpchksum += HTONS(ICMP_ECHO << 8) + 1; ++ } else { ++ ICMPBUF->icmpchksum += HTONS(ICMP_ECHO << 8); ++ } ++ ++ /* Swap IP addresses. */ ++ tmp16 = BUF->destipaddr[0]; ++ BUF->destipaddr[0] = BUF->srcipaddr[0]; ++ BUF->srcipaddr[0] = tmp16; ++ tmp16 = BUF->destipaddr[1]; ++ BUF->destipaddr[1] = BUF->srcipaddr[1]; ++ BUF->srcipaddr[1] = tmp16; ++ ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.sent); ++ goto send; ++ ++ /* End of IPv4 input header processing code. */ ++ ++ ++#if UIP_UDP ++ /* UDP input processing. */ ++ udp_input: ++ /* UDP processing is really just a hack. We don't do anything to the ++ UDP/IP headers, but let the UDP application do all the hard ++ work. If the application sets uip_slen, it has a packet to ++ send. */ ++#if UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS ++ if(uip_udpchksum() != 0xffff) { ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.udp.drop); ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.udp.chkerr); ++ UIP_LOG("udp: bad checksum."); ++ goto drop; ++ } ++#endif /* UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS */ ++ ++ /* Demultiplex this UDP packet between the UDP "connections". */ ++ for(uip_udp_conn = &uip_udp_conns[0]; ++ uip_udp_conn < &uip_udp_conns[UIP_UDP_CONNS]; ++ ++uip_udp_conn) { ++ if(uip_udp_conn->lport != 0 && ++ UDPBUF->destport == uip_udp_conn->lport && ++ (uip_udp_conn->rport == 0 || ++ UDPBUF->srcport == uip_udp_conn->rport) && ++ BUF->srcipaddr[0] == uip_udp_conn->ripaddr[0] && ++ BUF->srcipaddr[1] == uip_udp_conn->ripaddr[1]) { ++ goto udp_found; ++ } ++ } ++ goto drop; ++ ++ udp_found: ++ uip_len = uip_len - 28; ++ uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + 28]; ++ uip_flags = UIP_NEWDATA; ++ uip_slen = 0; ++ UIP_UDP_APPCALL(); ++ udp_send: ++ if(uip_slen == 0) { ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ uip_len = uip_slen + 28; ++ ++ BUF->len[0] = (uip_len >> 8); ++ BUF->len[1] = (uip_len & 0xff); ++ ++ BUF->proto = UIP_PROTO_UDP; ++ ++ UDPBUF->udplen = HTONS(uip_slen + 8); ++ UDPBUF->udpchksum = 0; ++#if UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS ++ /* Calculate UDP checksum. */ ++ UDPBUF->udpchksum = ~(uip_udpchksum()); ++ if(UDPBUF->udpchksum == 0) { ++ UDPBUF->udpchksum = 0xffff; ++ } ++#endif /* UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS */ ++ ++ BUF->srcport = uip_udp_conn->lport; ++ BUF->destport = uip_udp_conn->rport; ++ ++ BUF->srcipaddr[0] = uip_hostaddr[0]; ++ BUF->srcipaddr[1] = uip_hostaddr[1]; ++ BUF->destipaddr[0] = uip_udp_conn->ripaddr[0]; ++ BUF->destipaddr[1] = uip_udp_conn->ripaddr[1]; ++ ++ uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + 40]; ++ goto ip_send_nolen; ++#endif /* UIP_UDP */ ++ ++ /* TCP input processing. */ ++ tcp_input: ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.recv); ++ ++ /* Start of TCP input header processing code. */ ++ ++ if(uip_tcpchksum() != 0xffff) { /* Compute and check the TCP ++ checksum. */ ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.drop); ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.chkerr); ++ UIP_LOG("tcp: bad checksum."); ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ ++ /* Demultiplex this segment. */ ++ /* First check any active connections. */ ++ for(uip_connr = &uip_conns[0]; uip_connr < &uip_conns[UIP_CONNS]; ++uip_connr) { ++ if(uip_connr->tcpstateflags != CLOSED && ++ BUF->destport == uip_connr->lport && ++ BUF->srcport == uip_connr->rport && ++ BUF->srcipaddr[0] == uip_connr->ripaddr[0] && ++ BUF->srcipaddr[1] == uip_connr->ripaddr[1]) { ++ goto found; ++ } ++ } ++ ++ /* If we didn't find and active connection that expected the packet, ++ either this packet is an old duplicate, or this is a SYN packet ++ destined for a connection in LISTEN. If the SYN flag isn't set, ++ it is an old packet and we send a RST. */ ++ if((BUF->flags & TCP_CTL) != TCP_SYN) ++ goto reset; ++ ++ tmp16 = BUF->destport; ++ /* Next, check listening connections. */ ++ for(c = 0; c < UIP_LISTENPORTS; ++c) { ++ if(tmp16 == uip_listenports[c]) ++ goto found_listen; ++ } ++ ++ /* No matching connection found, so we send a RST packet. */ ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.synrst); ++ reset: ++ ++ /* We do not send resets in response to resets. */ ++ if(BUF->flags & TCP_RST) ++ goto drop; ++ ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.rst); ++ ++ BUF->flags = TCP_RST | TCP_ACK; ++ uip_len = 40; ++ BUF->tcpoffset = 5 << 4; ++ ++ /* Flip the seqno and ackno fields in the TCP header. */ ++ c = BUF->seqno[3]; ++ BUF->seqno[3] = BUF->ackno[3]; ++ BUF->ackno[3] = c; ++ ++ c = BUF->seqno[2]; ++ BUF->seqno[2] = BUF->ackno[2]; ++ BUF->ackno[2] = c; ++ ++ c = BUF->seqno[1]; ++ BUF->seqno[1] = BUF->ackno[1]; ++ BUF->ackno[1] = c; ++ ++ c = BUF->seqno[0]; ++ BUF->seqno[0] = BUF->ackno[0]; ++ BUF->ackno[0] = c; ++ ++ /* We also have to increase the sequence number we are ++ acknowledging. If the least significant byte overflowed, we need ++ to propagate the carry to the other bytes as well. */ ++ if(++BUF->ackno[3] == 0) { ++ if(++BUF->ackno[2] == 0) { ++ if(++BUF->ackno[1] == 0) { ++ ++BUF->ackno[0]; ++ } ++ } ++ } ++ ++ /* Swap port numbers. */ ++ tmp16 = BUF->srcport; ++ BUF->srcport = BUF->destport; ++ BUF->destport = tmp16; ++ ++ /* Swap IP addresses. */ ++ tmp16 = BUF->destipaddr[0]; ++ BUF->destipaddr[0] = BUF->srcipaddr[0]; ++ BUF->srcipaddr[0] = tmp16; ++ tmp16 = BUF->destipaddr[1]; ++ BUF->destipaddr[1] = BUF->srcipaddr[1]; ++ BUF->srcipaddr[1] = tmp16; ++ ++ ++ /* And send out the RST packet! */ ++ goto tcp_send_noconn; ++ ++ /* This label will be jumped to if we matched the incoming packet ++ with a connection in LISTEN. In that case, we should create a new ++ connection and send a SYNACK in return. */ ++ found_listen: ++ /* First we check if there are any connections avaliable. Unused ++ connections are kept in the same table as used connections, but ++ unused ones have the tcpstate set to CLOSED. Also, connections in ++ TIME_WAIT are kept track of and we'll use the oldest one if no ++ CLOSED connections are found. Thanks to Eddie C. Dost for a very ++ nice algorithm for the TIME_WAIT search. */ ++ uip_connr = 0; ++ for(c = 0; c < UIP_CONNS; ++c) { ++ if(uip_conns[c].tcpstateflags == CLOSED) { ++ uip_connr = &uip_conns[c]; ++ break; ++ } ++ if(uip_conns[c].tcpstateflags == TIME_WAIT) { ++ if(uip_connr == 0 || ++ uip_conns[c].timer > uip_connr->timer) { ++ uip_connr = &uip_conns[c]; ++ } ++ } ++ } ++ ++ if(uip_connr == 0) { ++ /* All connections are used already, we drop packet and hope that ++ the remote end will retransmit the packet at a time when we ++ have more spare connections. */ ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.syndrop); ++ UIP_LOG("tcp: found no unused connections."); ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ uip_conn = uip_connr; ++ ++ /* Fill in the necessary fields for the new connection. */ ++ uip_connr->rto = uip_connr->timer = UIP_RTO; ++ uip_connr->sa = 0; ++ uip_connr->sv = 4; ++ uip_connr->nrtx = 0; ++ uip_connr->lport = BUF->destport; ++ uip_connr->rport = BUF->srcport; ++ uip_connr->ripaddr[0] = BUF->srcipaddr[0]; ++ uip_connr->ripaddr[1] = BUF->srcipaddr[1]; ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = SYN_RCVD; ++ ++ uip_connr->snd_nxt[0] = iss[0]; ++ uip_connr->snd_nxt[1] = iss[1]; ++ uip_connr->snd_nxt[2] = iss[2]; ++ uip_connr->snd_nxt[3] = iss[3]; ++ uip_connr->len = 1; ++ ++ /* rcv_nxt should be the seqno from the incoming packet + 1. */ ++ uip_connr->rcv_nxt[3] = BUF->seqno[3]; ++ uip_connr->rcv_nxt[2] = BUF->seqno[2]; ++ uip_connr->rcv_nxt[1] = BUF->seqno[1]; ++ uip_connr->rcv_nxt[0] = BUF->seqno[0]; ++ uip_add_rcv_nxt(1); ++ ++ /* Parse the TCP MSS option, if present. */ ++ if((BUF->tcpoffset & 0xf0) > 0x50) { ++ for(c = 0; c < ((BUF->tcpoffset >> 4) - 5) << 2 ;) { ++ opt = uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + c]; ++ if(opt == 0x00) { ++ /* End of options. */ ++ break; ++ } else if(opt == 0x01) { ++ ++c; ++ /* NOP option. */ ++ } else if(opt == 0x02 && ++ uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c] == 0x04) { ++ /* An MSS option with the right option length. */ ++ tmp16 = ((unsigned short int)uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 2 + c] << 8) | ++ (unsigned short int)uip_buf[40 + UIP_LLH_LEN + 3 + c]; ++ uip_connr->initialmss = uip_connr->mss = ++ tmp16 > UIP_TCP_MSS? UIP_TCP_MSS: tmp16; ++ ++ /* And we are done processing options. */ ++ break; ++ } else { ++ /* All other options have a length field, so that we easily ++ can skip past them. */ ++ if(uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c] == 0) { ++ /* If the length field is zero, the options are malformed ++ and we don't process them further. */ ++ break; ++ } ++ c += uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c]; ++ } ++ } ++ } ++ ++ /* Our response will be a SYNACK. */ ++#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN ++ tcp_send_synack: ++ BUF->flags = TCP_ACK; ++ ++ tcp_send_syn: ++ BUF->flags |= TCP_SYN; ++#else /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ ++ tcp_send_synack: ++ BUF->flags = TCP_SYN | TCP_ACK; ++#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ ++ ++ /* We send out the TCP Maximum Segment Size option with our ++ SYNACK. */ ++ BUF->optdata[0] = 2; ++ BUF->optdata[1] = 4; ++ BUF->optdata[2] = (UIP_TCP_MSS) / 256; ++ BUF->optdata[3] = (UIP_TCP_MSS) & 255; ++ uip_len = 44; ++ BUF->tcpoffset = 6 << 4; ++ goto tcp_send; ++ ++ /* This label will be jumped to if we found an active connection. */ ++ found: ++ uip_conn = uip_connr; ++ uip_flags = 0; ++ ++ /* We do a very naive form of TCP reset processing; we just accept ++ any RST and kill our connection. We should in fact check if the ++ sequence number of this reset is wihtin our advertised window ++ before we accept the reset. */ ++ if(BUF->flags & TCP_RST) { ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = CLOSED; ++ UIP_LOG("tcp: got reset, aborting connection."); ++ uip_flags = UIP_ABORT; ++ UIP_APPCALL(); ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ /* Calculated the length of the data, if the application has sent ++ any data to us. */ ++ c = (BUF->tcpoffset >> 4) << 2; ++ /* uip_len will contain the length of the actual TCP data. This is ++ calculated by subtracing the length of the TCP header (in ++ c) and the length of the IP header (20 bytes). */ ++ uip_len = uip_len - c - 20; ++ ++ /* First, check if the sequence number of the incoming packet is ++ what we're expecting next. If not, we send out an ACK with the ++ correct numbers in. */ ++ if(uip_len > 0 && ++ (BUF->seqno[0] != uip_connr->rcv_nxt[0] || ++ BUF->seqno[1] != uip_connr->rcv_nxt[1] || ++ BUF->seqno[2] != uip_connr->rcv_nxt[2] || ++ BUF->seqno[3] != uip_connr->rcv_nxt[3])) { ++ goto tcp_send_ack; ++ } ++ ++ /* Next, check if the incoming segment acknowledges any outstanding ++ data. If so, we update the sequence number, reset the length of ++ the outstanding data, calculate RTT estimations, and reset the ++ retransmission timer. */ ++ if((BUF->flags & TCP_ACK) && uip_outstanding(uip_connr)) { ++ uip_add32(uip_connr->snd_nxt, uip_connr->len); ++ if(BUF->ackno[0] == uip_acc32[0] && ++ BUF->ackno[1] == uip_acc32[1] && ++ BUF->ackno[2] == uip_acc32[2] && ++ BUF->ackno[3] == uip_acc32[3]) { ++ /* Update sequence number. */ ++ uip_connr->snd_nxt[0] = uip_acc32[0]; ++ uip_connr->snd_nxt[1] = uip_acc32[1]; ++ uip_connr->snd_nxt[2] = uip_acc32[2]; ++ uip_connr->snd_nxt[3] = uip_acc32[3]; ++ ++ ++ /* Do RTT estimation, unless we have done retransmissions. */ ++ if(uip_connr->nrtx == 0) { ++ signed char m; ++ m = uip_connr->rto - uip_connr->timer; ++ /* This is taken directly from VJs original code in his paper */ ++ m = m - (uip_connr->sa >> 3); ++ uip_connr->sa += m; ++ if(m < 0) { ++ m = -m; ++ } ++ m = m - (uip_connr->sv >> 2); ++ uip_connr->sv += m; ++ uip_connr->rto = (uip_connr->sa >> 3) + uip_connr->sv; ++ ++ } ++ /* Set the acknowledged flag. */ ++ uip_flags = UIP_ACKDATA; ++ /* Reset the retransmission timer. */ ++ uip_connr->timer = uip_connr->rto; ++ } ++ ++ } ++ ++ /* Do different things depending on in what state the connection is. */ ++ switch(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & TS_MASK) { ++ /* CLOSED and LISTEN are not handled here. CLOSE_WAIT is not ++ implemented, since we force the application to close when the ++ peer sends a FIN (hence the application goes directly from ++ ESTABLISHED to LAST_ACK). */ ++ case SYN_RCVD: ++ /* In SYN_RCVD we have sent out a SYNACK in response to a SYN, and ++ we are waiting for an ACK that acknowledges the data we sent ++ out the last time. Therefore, we want to have the UIP_ACKDATA ++ flag set. If so, we enter the ESTABLISHED state. */ ++ if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = ESTABLISHED; ++ uip_flags = UIP_CONNECTED; ++ uip_connr->len = 0; ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ uip_flags |= UIP_NEWDATA; ++ uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_len); ++ } ++ uip_slen = 0; ++ UIP_APPCALL(); ++ goto appsend; ++ } ++ goto drop; ++#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN ++ case SYN_SENT: ++ /* In SYN_SENT, we wait for a SYNACK that is sent in response to ++ our SYN. The rcv_nxt is set to sequence number in the SYNACK ++ plus one, and we send an ACK. We move into the ESTABLISHED ++ state. */ ++ if((uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) && ++ BUF->flags == (TCP_SYN | TCP_ACK)) { ++ ++ /* Parse the TCP MSS option, if present. */ ++ if((BUF->tcpoffset & 0xf0) > 0x50) { ++ for(c = 0; c < ((BUF->tcpoffset >> 4) - 5) << 2 ;) { ++ opt = uip_buf[40 + UIP_LLH_LEN + c]; ++ if(opt == 0x00) { ++ /* End of options. */ ++ break; ++ } else if(opt == 0x01) { ++ ++c; ++ /* NOP option. */ ++ } else if(opt == 0x02 && ++ uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c] == 0x04) { ++ /* An MSS option with the right option length. */ ++ tmp16 = (uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 2 + c] << 8) | ++ uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 3 + c]; ++ uip_connr->initialmss = ++ uip_connr->mss = tmp16 > UIP_TCP_MSS? UIP_TCP_MSS: tmp16; ++ ++ /* And we are done processing options. */ ++ break; ++ } else { ++ /* All other options have a length field, so that we easily ++ can skip past them. */ ++ if(uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c] == 0) { ++ /* If the length field is zero, the options are malformed ++ and we don't process them further. */ ++ break; ++ } ++ c += uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c]; ++ } ++ } ++ } ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = ESTABLISHED; ++ uip_connr->rcv_nxt[0] = BUF->seqno[0]; ++ uip_connr->rcv_nxt[1] = BUF->seqno[1]; ++ uip_connr->rcv_nxt[2] = BUF->seqno[2]; ++ uip_connr->rcv_nxt[3] = BUF->seqno[3]; ++ uip_add_rcv_nxt(1); ++ uip_flags = UIP_CONNECTED | UIP_NEWDATA; ++ uip_connr->len = 0; ++ uip_len = 0; ++ uip_slen = 0; ++ UIP_APPCALL(); ++ goto appsend; ++ } ++ goto reset; ++#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ ++ ++ case ESTABLISHED: ++ /* In the ESTABLISHED state, we call upon the application to feed ++ data into the uip_buf. If the UIP_ACKDATA flag is set, the ++ application should put new data into the buffer, otherwise we are ++ retransmitting an old segment, and the application should put that ++ data into the buffer. ++ ++ If the incoming packet is a FIN, we should close the connection on ++ this side as well, and we send out a FIN and enter the LAST_ACK ++ state. We require that there is no outstanding data; otherwise the ++ sequence numbers will be screwed up. */ ++ ++ if(BUF->flags & TCP_FIN) { ++ if(uip_outstanding(uip_connr)) { ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ uip_add_rcv_nxt(1 + uip_len); ++ uip_flags = UIP_CLOSE; ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ uip_flags |= UIP_NEWDATA; ++ } ++ UIP_APPCALL(); ++ uip_connr->len = 1; ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = LAST_ACK; ++ uip_connr->nrtx = 0; ++ tcp_send_finack: ++ BUF->flags = TCP_FIN | TCP_ACK; ++ goto tcp_send_nodata; ++ } ++ ++ /* Check the URG flag. If this is set, the segment carries urgent ++ data that we must pass to the application. */ ++ if(BUF->flags & TCP_URG) { ++#if UIP_URGDATA > 0 ++ uip_urglen = (BUF->urgp[0] << 8) | BUF->urgp[1]; ++ if(uip_urglen > uip_len) { ++ /* There is more urgent data in the next segment to come. */ ++ uip_urglen = uip_len; ++ } ++ uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_urglen); ++ uip_len -= uip_urglen; ++ uip_urgdata = uip_appdata; ++ uip_appdata += uip_urglen; ++ } else { ++ uip_urglen = 0; ++#endif /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ ++ uip_appdata += (BUF->urgp[0] << 8) | BUF->urgp[1]; ++ uip_len -= (BUF->urgp[0] << 8) | BUF->urgp[1]; ++ } ++ ++ ++ /* If uip_len > 0 we have TCP data in the packet, and we flag this ++ by setting the UIP_NEWDATA flag and update the sequence number ++ we acknowledge. If the application has stopped the dataflow ++ using uip_stop(), we must not accept any data packets from the ++ remote host. */ ++ if(uip_len > 0 && !(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_STOPPED)) { ++ uip_flags |= UIP_NEWDATA; ++ uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_len); ++ } ++ ++ /* Check if the available buffer space advertised by the other end ++ is smaller than the initial MSS for this connection. If so, we ++ set the current MSS to the window size to ensure that the ++ application does not send more data than the other end can ++ handle. ++ ++ If the remote host advertises a zero window, we set the MSS to ++ the initial MSS so that the application will send an entire MSS ++ of data. This data will not be acknowledged by the receiver, ++ and the application will retransmit it. This is called the ++ "persistent timer" and uses the retransmission mechanim. ++ */ ++ tmp16 = ((unsigned short int)BUF->wnd[0] << 8) + (unsigned short int)BUF->wnd[1]; ++ if(tmp16 > uip_connr->initialmss || ++ tmp16 == 0) { ++ tmp16 = uip_connr->initialmss; ++ } ++ uip_connr->mss = tmp16; ++ ++ /* If this packet constitutes an ACK for outstanding data (flagged ++ by the UIP_ACKDATA flag, we should call the application since it ++ might want to send more data. If the incoming packet had data ++ from the peer (as flagged by the UIP_NEWDATA flag), the ++ application must also be notified. ++ ++ When the application is called, the global variable uip_len ++ contains the length of the incoming data. The application can ++ access the incoming data through the global pointer ++ uip_appdata, which usually points 40 bytes into the uip_buf ++ array. ++ ++ If the application wishes to send any data, this data should be ++ put into the uip_appdata and the length of the data should be ++ put into uip_len. If the application don't have any data to ++ send, uip_len must be set to 0. */ ++ if(uip_flags & (UIP_NEWDATA | UIP_ACKDATA)) { ++ uip_slen = 0; ++ UIP_APPCALL(); ++ ++ appsend: ++ ++ if(uip_flags & UIP_ABORT) { ++ uip_slen = 0; ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = CLOSED; ++ BUF->flags = TCP_RST | TCP_ACK; ++ goto tcp_send_nodata; ++ } ++ ++ if(uip_flags & UIP_CLOSE) { ++ uip_slen = 0; ++ uip_connr->len = 1; ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = FIN_WAIT_1; ++ uip_connr->nrtx = 0; ++ BUF->flags = TCP_FIN | TCP_ACK; ++ goto tcp_send_nodata; ++ } ++ ++ /* If uip_slen > 0, the application has data to be sent. */ ++ if(uip_slen > 0) { ++ ++ /* If the connection has acknowledged data, the contents of ++ the ->len variable should be discarded. */ ++ if((uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) != 0) { ++ uip_connr->len = 0; ++ } ++ ++ /* If the ->len variable is non-zero the connection has ++ already data in transit and cannot send anymore right ++ now. */ ++ if(uip_connr->len == 0) { ++ ++ /* The application cannot send more than what is allowed by ++ the mss (the minumum of the MSS and the available ++ window). */ ++ if(uip_slen > uip_connr->mss) { ++ uip_slen = uip_connr->mss; ++ } ++ ++ /* Remember how much data we send out now so that we know ++ when everything has been acknowledged. */ ++ uip_connr->len = uip_slen; ++ } else { ++ ++ /* If the application already had unacknowledged data, we ++ make sure that the application does not send (i.e., ++ retransmit) out more than it previously sent out. */ ++ uip_slen = uip_connr->len; ++ } ++ } else { ++ uip_connr->len = 0; ++ } ++ uip_connr->nrtx = 0; ++ apprexmit: ++ uip_appdata = uip_sappdata; ++ ++ /* If the application has data to be sent, or if the incoming ++ packet had new data in it, we must send out a packet. */ ++ if(uip_slen > 0 && uip_connr->len > 0) { ++ /* Add the length of the IP and TCP headers. */ ++ uip_len = uip_connr->len + UIP_TCPIP_HLEN; ++ /* We always set the ACK flag in response packets. */ ++ BUF->flags = TCP_ACK | TCP_PSH; ++ /* Send the packet. */ ++ goto tcp_send_noopts; ++ } ++ /* If there is no data to send, just send out a pure ACK if ++ there is newdata. */ ++ if(uip_flags & UIP_NEWDATA) { ++ uip_len = UIP_TCPIP_HLEN; ++ BUF->flags = TCP_ACK; ++ goto tcp_send_noopts; ++ } ++ } ++ goto drop; ++ case LAST_ACK: ++ /* We can close this connection if the peer has acknowledged our ++ FIN. This is indicated by the UIP_ACKDATA flag. */ ++ if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = CLOSED; ++ uip_flags = UIP_CLOSE; ++ UIP_APPCALL(); ++ } ++ break; ++ ++ case FIN_WAIT_1: ++ /* The application has closed the connection, but the remote host ++ hasn't closed its end yet. Thus we do nothing but wait for a ++ FIN from the other side. */ ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_len); ++ } ++ if(BUF->flags & TCP_FIN) { ++ if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = TIME_WAIT; ++ uip_connr->timer = 0; ++ uip_connr->len = 0; ++ } else { ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = CLOSING; ++ } ++ uip_add_rcv_nxt(1); ++ uip_flags = UIP_CLOSE; ++ UIP_APPCALL(); ++ goto tcp_send_ack; ++ } else if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = FIN_WAIT_2; ++ uip_connr->len = 0; ++ goto drop; ++ } ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ goto tcp_send_ack; ++ } ++ goto drop; ++ ++ case FIN_WAIT_2: ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_len); ++ } ++ if(BUF->flags & TCP_FIN) { ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = TIME_WAIT; ++ uip_connr->timer = 0; ++ uip_add_rcv_nxt(1); ++ uip_flags = UIP_CLOSE; ++ UIP_APPCALL(); ++ goto tcp_send_ack; ++ } ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ goto tcp_send_ack; ++ } ++ goto drop; ++ ++ case TIME_WAIT: ++ goto tcp_send_ack; ++ ++ case CLOSING: ++ if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { ++ uip_connr->tcpstateflags = TIME_WAIT; ++ uip_connr->timer = 0; ++ } ++ } ++ goto drop; ++ ++ ++ /* We jump here when we are ready to send the packet, and just want ++ to set the appropriate TCP sequence numbers in the TCP header. */ ++ tcp_send_ack: ++ BUF->flags = TCP_ACK; ++ tcp_send_nodata: ++ uip_len = 40; ++ tcp_send_noopts: ++ BUF->tcpoffset = 5 << 4; ++ tcp_send: ++ /* We're done with the input processing. We are now ready to send a ++ reply. Our job is to fill in all the fields of the TCP and IP ++ headers before calculating the checksum and finally send the ++ packet. */ ++ BUF->ackno[0] = uip_connr->rcv_nxt[0]; ++ BUF->ackno[1] = uip_connr->rcv_nxt[1]; ++ BUF->ackno[2] = uip_connr->rcv_nxt[2]; ++ BUF->ackno[3] = uip_connr->rcv_nxt[3]; ++ ++ BUF->seqno[0] = uip_connr->snd_nxt[0]; ++ BUF->seqno[1] = uip_connr->snd_nxt[1]; ++ BUF->seqno[2] = uip_connr->snd_nxt[2]; ++ BUF->seqno[3] = uip_connr->snd_nxt[3]; ++ ++ BUF->proto = UIP_PROTO_TCP; ++ ++ BUF->srcport = uip_connr->lport; ++ BUF->destport = uip_connr->rport; ++ ++ BUF->srcipaddr[0] = uip_hostaddr[0]; ++ BUF->srcipaddr[1] = uip_hostaddr[1]; ++ BUF->destipaddr[0] = uip_connr->ripaddr[0]; ++ BUF->destipaddr[1] = uip_connr->ripaddr[1]; ++ ++ ++ if(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_STOPPED) { ++ /* If the connection has issued uip_stop(), we advertise a zero ++ window so that the remote host will stop sending data. */ ++ BUF->wnd[0] = BUF->wnd[1] = 0; ++ } else { ++ BUF->wnd[0] = ((UIP_RECEIVE_WINDOW) >> 8); ++ BUF->wnd[1] = ((UIP_RECEIVE_WINDOW) & 0xff); ++ } ++ ++ tcp_send_noconn: ++ ++ BUF->len[0] = (uip_len >> 8); ++ BUF->len[1] = (uip_len & 0xff); ++ ++ /* Calculate TCP checksum. */ ++ BUF->tcpchksum = 0; ++ BUF->tcpchksum = ~(uip_tcpchksum()); ++ ++ //ip_send_nolen: ++ ++ BUF->vhl = 0x45; ++ BUF->tos = 0; ++ BUF->ipoffset[0] = BUF->ipoffset[1] = 0; ++ BUF->ttl = UIP_TTL; ++ ++ipid; ++ BUF->ipid[0] = ipid >> 8; ++ BUF->ipid[1] = ipid & 0xff; ++ ++ /* Calculate IP checksum. */ ++ BUF->ipchksum = 0; ++ BUF->ipchksum = ~(uip_ipchksum()); ++ ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.sent); ++ send: ++ UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.sent); ++ /* Return and let the caller do the actual transmission. */ ++ return; ++ drop: ++ uip_len = 0; ++ return; ++} ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/*unsigned short int ++htons(unsigned short int val) ++{ ++ return HTONS(val); ++}*/ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/** @} */ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/uip.h +@@ -0,0 +1,1066 @@ ++/** ++ * \addtogroup uip ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \file ++ * Header file for the uIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> ++ * ++ * The uIP TCP/IP stack header file contains definitions for a number ++ * of C macros that are used by uIP programs as well as internal uIP ++ * structures, TCP/IP header structures and function declarations. ++ * ++ */ ++ ++ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote ++ * products derived from this software without specific prior ++ * written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS ++ * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED ++ * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY ++ * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE ++ * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS ++ * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ++ * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING ++ * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS ++ * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * ++ * $Id: uip.h,v 1.36.2.7 2003/10/07 13:47:51 adam Exp $ ++ * ++ */ ++ ++#ifndef __UIP_H__ ++#define __UIP_H__ ++#include <linux/types.h> ++#include <linux/string.h> ++#include <linux/ctype.h> ++#include <malloc.h> ++#include <common.h> ++ ++ ++#include "uipopt.h" ++ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/* First, the functions that should be called from the ++ * system. Initialization, the periodic timer and incoming packets are ++ * handled by the following three functions. ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipconffunc uIP configuration functions ++ * @{ ++ * ++ * The uIP configuration functions are used for setting run-time ++ * parameters in uIP such as IP addresses. ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * Set the IP address of this host. ++ * ++ * The IP address is represented as a 4-byte array where the first ++ * octet of the IP address is put in the first member of the 4-byte ++ * array. ++ * ++ * \param addr A pointer to a 4-byte representation of the IP address. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_sethostaddr(addr) do { uip_hostaddr[0] = addr[0]; \ ++ uip_hostaddr[1] = addr[1]; } while(0) ++ ++/** ++ * Get the IP address of this host. ++ * ++ * The IP address is represented as a 4-byte array where the first ++ * octet of the IP address is put in the first member of the 4-byte ++ * array. ++ * ++ * \param addr A pointer to a 4-byte array that will be filled in with ++ * the currently configured IP address. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_gethostaddr(addr) do { addr[0] = uip_hostaddr[0]; \ ++ addr[1] = uip_hostaddr[1]; } while(0) ++ ++/** @} */ ++ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipinit uIP initialization functions ++ * @{ ++ * ++ * The uIP initialization functions are used for booting uIP. ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * uIP initialization function. ++ * ++ * This function should be called at boot up to initilize the uIP ++ * TCP/IP stack. ++ */ ++void uip_init(void); ++ ++/** @} */ ++ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipdevfunc uIP device driver functions ++ * @{ ++ * ++ * These functions are used by a network device driver for interacting ++ * with uIP. ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * Process an incoming packet. ++ * ++ * This function should be called when the device driver has received ++ * a packet from the network. The packet from the device driver must ++ * be present in the uip_buf buffer, and the length of the packet ++ * should be placed in the uip_len variable. ++ * ++ * When the function returns, there may be an outbound packet placed ++ * in the uip_buf packet buffer. If so, the uip_len variable is set to ++ * the length of the packet. If no packet is to be sent out, the ++ * uip_len variable is set to 0. ++ * ++ * The usual way of calling the function is presented by the source ++ * code below. ++ \code ++ uip_len = devicedriver_poll(); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ uip_input(); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ devicedriver_send(); ++ } ++ } ++ \endcode ++ * ++ * \note If you are writing a uIP device driver that needs ARP ++ * (Address Resolution Protocol), e.g., when running uIP over ++ * Ethernet, you will need to call the uIP ARP code before calling ++ * this function: ++ \code ++ #define BUF ((struct uip_eth_hdr *)&uip_buf[0]) ++ uip_len = ethernet_devicedrver_poll(); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ if(BUF->type == HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_IP)) { ++ uip_arp_ipin(); ++ uip_input(); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ uip_arp_out(); ++ ethernet_devicedriver_send(); ++ } ++ } else if(BUF->type == HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP)) { ++ uip_arp_arpin(); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ ethernet_devicedriver_send(); ++ } ++ } ++ \endcode ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_input() uip_process(UIP_DATA) ++ ++/** ++ * Periodic processing for a connection identified by its number. ++ * ++ * This function does the necessary periodic processing (timers, ++ * polling) for a uIP TCP conneciton, and should be called when the ++ * periodic uIP timer goes off. It should be called for every ++ * connection, regardless of whether they are open of closed. ++ * ++ * When the function returns, it may have an outbound packet waiting ++ * for service in the uIP packet buffer, and if so the uip_len ++ * variable is set to a value larger than zero. The device driver ++ * should be called to send out the packet. ++ * ++ * The ususal way of calling the function is through a for() loop like ++ * this: ++ \code ++ for(i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; ++i) { ++ uip_periodic(i); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ devicedriver_send(); ++ } ++ } ++ \endcode ++ * ++ * \note If you are writing a uIP device driver that needs ARP ++ * (Address Resolution Protocol), e.g., when running uIP over ++ * Ethernet, you will need to call the uip_arp_out() function before ++ * calling the device driver: ++ \code ++ for(i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; ++i) { ++ uip_periodic(i); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ uip_arp_out(); ++ ethernet_devicedriver_send(); ++ } ++ } ++ \endcode ++ * ++ * \param conn The number of the connection which is to be periodically polled. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_periodic(conn) do { uip_conn = &uip_conns[conn]; \ ++ uip_process(UIP_TIMER); } while (0) ++ ++/** ++ * Periodic processing for a connection identified by a pointer to its structure. ++ * ++ * Same as uip_periodic() but takes a pointer to the actual uip_conn ++ * struct instead of an integer as its argument. This function can be ++ * used to force periodic processing of a specific connection. ++ * ++ * \param conn A pointer to the uip_conn struct for the connection to ++ * be processed. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_periodic_conn(conn) do { uip_conn = conn; \ ++ uip_process(UIP_TIMER); } while (0) ++ ++#if UIP_UDP ++/** ++ * Periodic processing for a UDP connection identified by its number. ++ * ++ * This function is essentially the same as uip_prerioic(), but for ++ * UDP connections. It is called in a similar fashion as the ++ * uip_periodic() function: ++ \code ++ for(i = 0; i < UIP_UDP_CONNS; i++) { ++ uip_udp_periodic(i); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ devicedriver_send(); ++ } ++ } ++ \endcode ++ * ++ * \note As for the uip_periodic() function, special care has to be ++ * taken when using uIP together with ARP and Ethernet: ++ \code ++ for(i = 0; i < UIP_UDP_CONNS; i++) { ++ uip_udp_periodic(i); ++ if(uip_len > 0) { ++ uip_arp_out(); ++ ethernet_devicedriver_send(); ++ } ++ } ++ \endcode ++ * ++ * \param conn The number of the UDP connection to be processed. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_udp_periodic(conn) do { uip_udp_conn = &uip_udp_conns[conn]; \ ++ uip_process(UIP_UDP_TIMER); } while (0) ++ ++/** ++ * Periodic processing for a UDP connection identified by a pointer to ++ * its structure. ++ * ++ * Same as uip_udp_periodic() but takes a pointer to the actual ++ * uip_conn struct instead of an integer as its argument. This ++ * function can be used to force periodic processing of a specific ++ * connection. ++ * ++ * \param conn A pointer to the uip_udp_conn struct for the connection ++ * to be processed. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_udp_periodic_conn(conn) do { uip_udp_conn = conn; \ ++ uip_process(UIP_UDP_TIMER); } while (0) ++ ++ ++#endif /* UIP_UDP */ ++ ++/** ++ * The uIP packet buffer. ++ * ++ * The uip_buf array is used to hold incoming and outgoing ++ * packets. The device driver should place incoming data into this ++ * buffer. When sending data, the device driver should read the link ++ * level headers and the TCP/IP headers from this buffer. The size of ++ * the link level headers is configured by the UIP_LLH_LEN define. ++ * ++ * \note The application data need not be placed in this buffer, so ++ * the device driver must read it from the place pointed to by the ++ * uip_appdata pointer as illustrated by the following example: ++ \code ++ void ++ devicedriver_send(void) ++ { ++ hwsend(&uip_buf[0], UIP_LLH_LEN); ++ hwsend(&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN], 40); ++ hwsend(uip_appdata, uip_len - 40 - UIP_LLH_LEN); ++ } ++ \endcode ++ */ ++extern u8_t uip_buf[UIP_BUFSIZE+2]; ++ ++/** @} */ ++ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/* Functions that are used by the uIP application program. Opening and ++ * closing connections, sending and receiving data, etc. is all ++ * handled by the functions below. ++*/ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipappfunc uIP application functions ++ * @{ ++ * ++ * Functions used by an application running of top of uIP. ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * Start listening to the specified port. ++ * ++ * \note Since this function expects the port number in network byte ++ * order, a conversion using HTONS() or htons() is necessary. ++ * ++ \code ++ uip_listen(HTONS(80)); ++ \endcode ++ * ++ * \param port A 16-bit port number in network byte order. ++ */ ++void uip_listen(u16_t port); ++ ++/** ++ * Stop listening to the specified port. ++ * ++ * \note Since this function expects the port number in network byte ++ * order, a conversion using HTONS() or htons() is necessary. ++ * ++ \code ++ uip_unlisten(HTONS(80)); ++ \endcode ++ * ++ * \param port A 16-bit port number in network byte order. ++ */ ++void uip_unlisten(u16_t port); ++ ++/** ++ * Connect to a remote host using TCP. ++ * ++ * This function is used to start a new connection to the specified ++ * port on the specied host. It allocates a new connection identifier, ++ * sets the connection to the SYN_SENT state and sets the ++ * retransmission timer to 0. This will cause a TCP SYN segment to be ++ * sent out the next time this connection is periodically processed, ++ * which usually is done within 0.5 seconds after the call to ++ * uip_connect(). ++ * ++ * \note This function is avaliable only if support for active open ++ * has been configured by defining UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN to 1 in uipopt.h. ++ * ++ * \note Since this function requires the port number to be in network ++ * byte order, a convertion using HTONS() or htons() is necessary. ++ * ++ \code ++ u16_t ipaddr[2]; ++ ++ uip_ipaddr(ipaddr, 192,168,1,2); ++ uip_connect(ipaddr, HTONS(80)); ++ \endcode ++ * ++ * \param ripaddr A pointer to a 4-byte array representing the IP ++ * address of the remote hot. ++ * ++ * \param port A 16-bit port number in network byte order. ++ * ++ * \return A pointer to the uIP connection identifier for the new connection, ++ * or NULL if no connection could be allocated. ++ * ++ */ ++struct uip_conn *uip_connect(u16_t *ripaddr, u16_t port); ++ ++ ++ ++/** ++ * \internal ++ * ++ * Check if a connection has outstanding (i.e., unacknowledged) data. ++ * ++ * \param conn A pointer to the uip_conn structure for the connection. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_outstanding(conn) ((conn)->len) ++ ++/** ++ * Send data on the current connection. ++ * ++ * This function is used to send out a single segment of TCP ++ * data. Only applications that have been invoked by uIP for event ++ * processing can send data. ++ * ++ * The amount of data that actually is sent out after a call to this ++ * funcion is determined by the maximum amount of data TCP allows. uIP ++ * will automatically crop the data so that only the appropriate ++ * amount of data is sent. The function uip_mss() can be used to query ++ * uIP for the amount of data that actually will be sent. ++ * ++ * \note This function does not guarantee that the sent data will ++ * arrive at the destination. If the data is lost in the network, the ++ * application will be invoked with the uip_rexmit() event being ++ * set. The application will then have to resend the data using this ++ * function. ++ * ++ * \param data A pointer to the data which is to be sent. ++ * ++ * \param len The maximum amount of data bytes to be sent. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_send(data, len) do { uip_sappdata = (data); uip_slen = (len);} while(0) ++ ++/** ++ * The length of any incoming data that is currently avaliable (if avaliable) ++ * in the uip_appdata buffer. ++ * ++ * The test function uip_data() must first be used to check if there ++ * is any data available at all. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_datalen() uip_len ++ ++/** ++ * The length of any out-of-band data (urgent data) that has arrived ++ * on the connection. ++ * ++ * \note The configuration parameter UIP_URGDATA must be set for this ++ * function to be enabled. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_urgdatalen() uip_urglen ++ ++/** ++ * Close the current connection. ++ * ++ * This function will close the current connection in a nice way. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_close() (uip_flags = UIP_CLOSE) ++ ++/** ++ * Abort the current connection. ++ * ++ * This function will abort (reset) the current connection, and is ++ * usually used when an error has occured that prevents using the ++ * uip_close() function. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_abort() (uip_flags = UIP_ABORT) ++ ++/** ++ * Tell the sending host to stop sending data. ++ * ++ * This function will close our receiver's window so that we stop ++ * receiving data for the current connection. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_stop() (uip_conn->tcpstateflags |= UIP_STOPPED) ++ ++/** ++ * Find out if the current connection has been previously stopped with ++ * uip_stop(). ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_stopped(conn) ((conn)->tcpstateflags & UIP_STOPPED) ++ ++/** ++ * Restart the current connection, if is has previously been stopped ++ * with uip_stop(). ++ * ++ * This function will open the receiver's window again so that we ++ * start receiving data for the current connection. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_restart() do { uip_flags |= UIP_NEWDATA; \ ++ uip_conn->tcpstateflags &= ~UIP_STOPPED; \ ++ } while(0) ++ ++ ++/* uIP tests that can be made to determine in what state the current ++ connection is, and what the application function should do. */ ++ ++/** ++ * Is new incoming data available? ++ * ++ * Will reduce to non-zero if there is new data for the application ++ * present at the uip_appdata pointer. The size of the data is ++ * avaliable through the uip_len variable. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_newdata() (uip_flags & UIP_NEWDATA) ++ ++/** ++ * Has previously sent data been acknowledged? ++ * ++ * Will reduce to non-zero if the previously sent data has been ++ * acknowledged by the remote host. This means that the application ++ * can send new data. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_acked() (uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) ++ ++/** ++ * Has the connection just been connected? ++ * ++ * Reduces to non-zero if the current connection has been connected to ++ * a remote host. This will happen both if the connection has been ++ * actively opened (with uip_connect()) or passively opened (with ++ * uip_listen()). ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_connected() (uip_flags & UIP_CONNECTED) ++ ++/** ++ * Has the connection been closed by the other end? ++ * ++ * Is non-zero if the connection has been closed by the remote ++ * host. The application may then do the necessary clean-ups. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_closed() (uip_flags & UIP_CLOSE) ++ ++/** ++ * Has the connection been aborted by the other end? ++ * ++ * Non-zero if the current connection has been aborted (reset) by the ++ * remote host. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_aborted() (uip_flags & UIP_ABORT) ++ ++/** ++ * Has the connection timed out? ++ * ++ * Non-zero if the current connection has been aborted due to too many ++ * retransmissions. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_timedout() (uip_flags & UIP_TIMEDOUT) ++ ++/** ++ * Do we need to retransmit previously data? ++ * ++ * Reduces to non-zero if the previously sent data has been lost in ++ * the network, and the application should retransmit it. The ++ * application should send the exact same data as it did the last ++ * time, using the uip_send() function. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_rexmit() (uip_flags & UIP_REXMIT) ++ ++/** ++ * Is the connection being polled by uIP? ++ * ++ * Is non-zero if the reason the application is invoked is that the ++ * current connection has been idle for a while and should be ++ * polled. ++ * ++ * The polling event can be used for sending data without having to ++ * wait for the remote host to send data. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_poll() (uip_flags & UIP_POLL) ++ ++/** ++ * Get the initial maxium segment size (MSS) of the current ++ * connection. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_initialmss() (uip_conn->initialmss) ++ ++/** ++ * Get the current maxium segment size that can be sent on the current ++ * connection. ++ * ++ * The current maxiumum segment size that can be sent on the ++ * connection is computed from the receiver's window and the MSS of ++ * the connection (which also is available by calling ++ * uip_initialmss()). ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_mss() (uip_conn->mss) ++ ++/** ++ * Set up a new UDP connection. ++ * ++ * \param ripaddr A pointer to a 4-byte structure representing the IP ++ * address of the remote host. ++ * ++ * \param rport The remote port number in network byte order. ++ * ++ * \return The uip_udp_conn structure for the new connection or NULL ++ * if no connection could be allocated. ++ */ ++struct uip_udp_conn *uip_udp_new(u16_t *ripaddr, u16_t rport); ++ ++/** ++ * Removed a UDP connection. ++ * ++ * \param conn A pointer to the uip_udp_conn structure for the connection. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_udp_remove(conn) (conn)->lport = 0 ++ ++/** ++ * Send a UDP datagram of length len on the current connection. ++ * ++ * This function can only be called in response to a UDP event (poll ++ * or newdata). The data must be present in the uip_buf buffer, at the ++ * place pointed to by the uip_appdata pointer. ++ * ++ * \param len The length of the data in the uip_buf buffer. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_udp_send(len) uip_slen = (len) ++ ++/** @} */ ++ ++/* uIP convenience and converting functions. */ ++ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipconvfunc uIP conversion functions ++ * @{ ++ * ++ * These functions can be used for converting between different data ++ * formats used by uIP. ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * Pack an IP address into a 4-byte array which is used by uIP to ++ * represent IP addresses. ++ * ++ * Example: ++ \code ++ u16_t ipaddr[2]; ++ ++ uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr, 192,168,1,2); ++ \endcode ++ * ++ * \param addr A pointer to a 4-byte array that will be filled in with ++ * the IP addres. ++ * \param addr0 The first octet of the IP address. ++ * \param addr1 The second octet of the IP address. ++ * \param addr2 The third octet of the IP address. ++ * \param addr3 The forth octet of the IP address. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define uip_ipaddr(addr, addr0,addr1,addr2,addr3) do { \ ++ (addr)[0] = HTONS(((addr0) << 8) | (addr1)); \ ++ (addr)[1] = HTONS(((addr2) << 8) | (addr3)); \ ++ } while(0) ++ ++/** ++ * Convert 16-bit quantity from host byte order to network byte order. ++ * ++ * This macro is primarily used for converting constants from host ++ * byte order to network byte order. For converting variables to ++ * network byte order, use the htons() function instead. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#ifndef HTONS ++# if BYTE_ORDER == BIG_ENDIAN ++# define HTONS(n) (n) ++# else /* BYTE_ORDER == BIG_ENDIAN */ ++# define HTONS(n) ((((u16_t)((n) & 0xff)) << 8) | (((n) & 0xff00) >> 8)) ++# endif /* BYTE_ORDER == BIG_ENDIAN */ ++#endif /* HTONS */ ++ ++/** ++ * Convert 16-bit quantity from host byte order to network byte order. ++ * ++ * This function is primarily used for converting variables from host ++ * byte order to network byte order. For converting constants to ++ * network byte order, use the HTONS() macro instead. ++ */ ++#ifndef htons ++u16_t htons(u16_t val); ++#endif /* htons */ ++ ++/** @} */ ++ ++/** ++ * Pointer to the application data in the packet buffer. ++ * ++ * This pointer points to the application data when the application is ++ * called. If the application wishes to send data, the application may ++ * use this space to write the data into before calling uip_send(). ++ */ ++extern volatile u8_t *uip_appdata; ++extern volatile u8_t *uip_sappdata; ++ ++#if UIP_URGDATA > 0 ++/* u8_t *uip_urgdata: ++ * ++ * This pointer points to any urgent data that has been received. Only ++ * present if compiled with support for urgent data (UIP_URGDATA). ++ */ ++extern volatile u8_t *uip_urgdata; ++#endif /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ ++ ++ ++/* u[8|16]_t uip_len: ++ * ++ * When the application is called, uip_len contains the length of any ++ * new data that has been received from the remote host. The ++ * application should set this variable to the size of any data that ++ * the application wishes to send. When the network device driver ++ * output function is called, uip_len should contain the length of the ++ * outgoing packet. ++ */ ++extern volatile u16_t uip_len, uip_slen; ++ ++#if UIP_URGDATA > 0 ++extern volatile u8_t uip_urglen, uip_surglen; ++#endif /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ ++ ++ ++/** ++ * Representation of a uIP TCP connection. ++ * ++ * The uip_conn structure is used for identifying a connection. All ++ * but one field in the structure are to be considered read-only by an ++ * application. The only exception is the appstate field whos purpose ++ * is to let the application store application-specific state (e.g., ++ * file pointers) for the connection. The size of this field is ++ * configured in the "uipopt.h" header file. ++ */ ++struct uip_conn { ++ u16_t ripaddr[2]; /**< The IP address of the remote host. */ ++ ++ u16_t lport; /**< The local TCP port, in network byte order. */ ++ u16_t rport; /**< The local remote TCP port, in network byte ++ order. */ ++ ++ u8_t rcv_nxt[4]; /**< The sequence number that we expect to ++ receive next. */ ++ u8_t snd_nxt[4]; /**< The sequence number that was last sent by ++ us. */ ++ u16_t len; /**< Length of the data that was previously sent. */ ++ u16_t mss; /**< Current maximum segment size for the ++ connection. */ ++ u16_t initialmss; /**< Initial maximum segment size for the ++ connection. */ ++ u8_t sa; /**< Retransmission time-out calculation state ++ variable. */ ++ u8_t sv; /**< Retransmission time-out calculation state ++ variable. */ ++ u8_t rto; /**< Retransmission time-out. */ ++ u8_t tcpstateflags; /**< TCP state and flags. */ ++ u8_t timer; /**< The retransmission timer. */ ++ u8_t nrtx; /**< The number of retransmissions for the last ++ segment sent. */ ++ ++ /** The application state. */ ++ u8_t appstate[UIP_APPSTATE_SIZE]; ++}; ++ ++ ++/* Pointer to the current connection. */ ++extern struct uip_conn *uip_conn; ++/* The array containing all uIP connections. */ ++extern struct uip_conn uip_conns[UIP_CONNS]; ++/** ++ * \addtogroup uiparch ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * 4-byte array used for the 32-bit sequence number calculations. ++ */ ++extern volatile u8_t uip_acc32[4]; ++ ++/** @} */ ++ ++ ++#if UIP_UDP ++/** ++ * Representation of a uIP UDP connection. ++ */ ++struct uip_udp_conn { ++ u16_t ripaddr[2]; /**< The IP address of the remote peer. */ ++ u16_t lport; /**< The local port number in network byte order. */ ++ u16_t rport; /**< The remote port number in network byte order. */ ++}; ++ ++extern struct uip_udp_conn *uip_udp_conn; ++extern struct uip_udp_conn uip_udp_conns[UIP_UDP_CONNS]; ++#endif /* UIP_UDP */ ++ ++/** ++ * The structure holding the TCP/IP statistics that are gathered if ++ * UIP_STATISTICS is set to 1. ++ * ++ */ ++struct uip_stats { ++ struct { ++ uip_stats_t drop; /**< Number of dropped packets at the IP ++ layer. */ ++ uip_stats_t recv; /**< Number of received packets at the IP ++ layer. */ ++ uip_stats_t sent; /**< Number of sent packets at the IP ++ layer. */ ++ uip_stats_t vhlerr; /**< Number of packets dropped due to wrong ++ IP version or header length. */ ++ uip_stats_t hblenerr; /**< Number of packets dropped due to wrong ++ IP length, high byte. */ ++ uip_stats_t lblenerr; /**< Number of packets dropped due to wrong ++ IP length, low byte. */ ++ uip_stats_t fragerr; /**< Number of packets dropped since they ++ were IP fragments. */ ++ uip_stats_t chkerr; /**< Number of packets dropped due to IP ++ checksum errors. */ ++ uip_stats_t protoerr; /**< Number of packets dropped since they ++ were neither ICMP, UDP nor TCP. */ ++ } ip; /**< IP statistics. */ ++ struct { ++ uip_stats_t drop; /**< Number of dropped ICMP packets. */ ++ uip_stats_t recv; /**< Number of received ICMP packets. */ ++ uip_stats_t sent; /**< Number of sent ICMP packets. */ ++ uip_stats_t typeerr; /**< Number of ICMP packets with a wrong ++ type. */ ++ } icmp; /**< ICMP statistics. */ ++ struct { ++ uip_stats_t drop; /**< Number of dropped TCP segments. */ ++ uip_stats_t recv; /**< Number of recived TCP segments. */ ++ uip_stats_t sent; /**< Number of sent TCP segments. */ ++ uip_stats_t chkerr; /**< Number of TCP segments with a bad ++ checksum. */ ++ uip_stats_t ackerr; /**< Number of TCP segments with a bad ACK ++ number. */ ++ uip_stats_t rst; /**< Number of recevied TCP RST (reset) segments. */ ++ uip_stats_t rexmit; /**< Number of retransmitted TCP segments. */ ++ uip_stats_t syndrop; /**< Number of dropped SYNs due to too few ++ connections was avaliable. */ ++ uip_stats_t synrst; /**< Number of SYNs for closed ports, ++ triggering a RST. */ ++ } tcp; /**< TCP statistics. */ ++}; ++ ++/** ++ * The uIP TCP/IP statistics. ++ * ++ * This is the variable in which the uIP TCP/IP statistics are gathered. ++ */ ++extern struct uip_stats uip_stat; ++ ++ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/* All the stuff below this point is internal to uIP and should not be ++ * used directly by an application or by a device driver. ++ */ ++/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/* u8_t uip_flags: ++ * ++ * When the application is called, uip_flags will contain the flags ++ * that are defined in this file. Please read below for more ++ * infomation. ++ */ ++extern volatile u8_t uip_flags; ++ ++/* The following flags may be set in the global variable uip_flags ++ before calling the application callback. The UIP_ACKDATA and ++ UIP_NEWDATA flags may both be set at the same time, whereas the ++ others are mutualy exclusive. Note that these flags should *NOT* be ++ accessed directly, but through the uIP functions/macros. */ ++ ++#define UIP_ACKDATA 1 /* Signifies that the outstanding data was ++ acked and the application should send ++ out new data instead of retransmitting ++ the last data. */ ++#define UIP_NEWDATA 2 /* Flags the fact that the peer has sent ++ us new data. */ ++#define UIP_REXMIT 4 /* Tells the application to retransmit the ++ data that was last sent. */ ++#define UIP_POLL 8 /* Used for polling the application, to ++ check if the application has data that ++ it wants to send. */ ++#define UIP_CLOSE 16 /* The remote host has closed the ++ connection, thus the connection has ++ gone away. Or the application signals ++ that it wants to close the ++ connection. */ ++#define UIP_ABORT 32 /* The remote host has aborted the ++ connection, thus the connection has ++ gone away. Or the application signals ++ that it wants to abort the ++ connection. */ ++#define UIP_CONNECTED 64 /* We have got a connection from a remote ++ host and have set up a new connection ++ for it, or an active connection has ++ been successfully established. */ ++ ++#define UIP_TIMEDOUT 128 /* The connection has been aborted due to ++ too many retransmissions. */ ++ ++ ++/* uip_process(flag): ++ * ++ * The actual uIP function which does all the work. ++ */ ++void uip_process(u8_t flag); ++ ++/* The following flags are passed as an argument to the uip_process() ++ function. They are used to distinguish between the two cases where ++ uip_process() is called. It can be called either because we have ++ incoming data that should be processed, or because the periodic ++ timer has fired. */ ++ ++#define UIP_DATA 1 /* Tells uIP that there is incoming data in ++ the uip_buf buffer. The length of the ++ data is stored in the global variable ++ uip_len. */ ++#define UIP_TIMER 2 /* Tells uIP that the periodic timer has ++ fired. */ ++#if UIP_UDP ++#define UIP_UDP_TIMER 3 ++#endif /* UIP_UDP */ ++ ++/* The TCP states used in the uip_conn->tcpstateflags. */ ++#define CLOSED 0 ++#define SYN_RCVD 1 ++#define SYN_SENT 2 ++#define ESTABLISHED 3 ++#define FIN_WAIT_1 4 ++#define FIN_WAIT_2 5 ++#define CLOSING 6 ++#define TIME_WAIT 7 ++#define LAST_ACK 8 ++#define TS_MASK 15 ++ ++#define UIP_STOPPED 16 ++ ++#define UIP_TCPIP_HLEN 40 ++ ++/* The TCP and IP headers. */ ++typedef struct { ++ /* IP header. */ ++ u8_t vhl, ++ tos, ++ len[2], ++ ipid[2], ++ ipoffset[2], ++ ttl, ++ proto; ++ u16_t ipchksum; ++ u16_t srcipaddr[2], ++ destipaddr[2]; ++ ++ /* TCP header. */ ++ u16_t srcport, ++ destport; ++ u8_t seqno[4], ++ ackno[4], ++ tcpoffset, ++ flags, ++ wnd[2]; ++ u16_t tcpchksum; ++ u8_t urgp[2]; ++ u8_t optdata[4]; ++} uip_tcpip_hdr; ++ ++/* The ICMP and IP headers. */ ++typedef struct { ++ /* IP header. */ ++ u8_t vhl, ++ tos, ++ len[2], ++ ipid[2], ++ ipoffset[2], ++ ttl, ++ proto; ++ u16_t ipchksum; ++ u16_t srcipaddr[2], ++ destipaddr[2]; ++ /* ICMP (echo) header. */ ++ u8_t type, icode; ++ u16_t icmpchksum; ++ u16_t id, seqno; ++} uip_icmpip_hdr; ++ ++ ++/* The UDP and IP headers. */ ++typedef struct { ++ /* IP header. */ ++ u8_t vhl, ++ tos, ++ len[2], ++ ipid[2], ++ ipoffset[2], ++ ttl, ++ proto; ++ u16_t ipchksum; ++ u16_t srcipaddr[2], ++ destipaddr[2]; ++ ++ /* UDP header. */ ++ u16_t srcport, ++ destport; ++ u16_t udplen; ++ u16_t udpchksum; ++} uip_udpip_hdr; ++ ++#define UIP_PROTO_ICMP 1 ++#define UIP_PROTO_TCP 6 ++#define UIP_PROTO_UDP 17 ++ ++#if UIP_FIXEDADDR ++extern const u16_t uip_hostaddr[2]; ++#else /* UIP_FIXEDADDR */ ++extern u16_t uip_hostaddr[2]; ++#endif /* UIP_FIXEDADDR */ ++ ++#endif /* __UIP_H__ */ ++ ++ ++/** @} */ ++ +--- /dev/null ++++ b/net/uip-0.9/uipopt.h +@@ -0,0 +1,557 @@ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipopt Configuration options for uIP ++ * @{ ++ * ++ * uIP is configured using the per-project configuration file ++ * "uipopt.h". This file contains all compile-time options for uIP and ++ * should be tweaked to match each specific project. The uIP ++ * distribution contains a documented example "uipopt.h" that can be ++ * copied and modified for each project. ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \file ++ * Configuration options for uIP. ++ * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> ++ * ++ * This file is used for tweaking various configuration options for ++ * uIP. You should make a copy of this file into one of your project's ++ * directories instead of editing this example "uipopt.h" file that ++ * comes with the uIP distribution. ++ */ ++ ++/* ++ * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. ++ * All rights reserved. ++ * ++ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without ++ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions ++ * are met: ++ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ++ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ++ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the ++ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. ++ * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote ++ * products derived from this software without specific prior ++ * written permission. ++ * ++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS ++ * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED ++ * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ++ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY ++ * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL ++ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE ++ * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS ++ * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ++ * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING ++ * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS ++ * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ++ * ++ * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. ++ * ++ * $Id: uipopt.h,v 1.16.2.5 2003/10/07 13:22:51 adam Exp $ ++ * ++ */ ++ ++#ifndef __UIPOPT_H__ ++#define __UIPOPT_H__ ++ ++/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipopttypedef uIP type definitions ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * The 8-bit unsigned data type. ++ * ++ * This may have to be tweaked for your particular compiler. "unsigned ++ * char" works for most compilers. ++ */ ++typedef unsigned char u8_t; ++ ++/** ++ * The 16-bit unsigned data type. ++ * ++ * This may have to be tweaked for your particular compiler. "unsigned ++ * short" works for most compilers. ++ */ ++typedef unsigned short u16_t; ++ ++/** ++ * The statistics data type. ++ * ++ * This datatype determines how high the statistics counters are able ++ * to count. ++ */ ++typedef unsigned short uip_stats_t; ++ ++/** @} */ ++ ++/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipoptstaticconf Static configuration options ++ * @{ ++ * ++ * These configuration options can be used for setting the IP address ++ * settings statically, but only if UIP_FIXEDADDR is set to 1. The ++ * configuration options for a specific node includes IP address, ++ * netmask and default router as well as the Ethernet address. The ++ * netmask, default router and Ethernet address are appliciable only ++ * if uIP should be run over Ethernet. ++ * ++ * All of these should be changed to suit your project. ++*/ ++ ++/** ++ * Determines if uIP should use a fixed IP address or not. ++ * ++ * If uIP should use a fixed IP address, the settings are set in the ++ * uipopt.h file. If not, the macros uip_sethostaddr(), ++ * uip_setdraddr() and uip_setnetmask() should be used instead. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_FIXEDADDR 0 ++ ++/** ++ * Ping IP address asignment. ++ * ++ * uIP uses a "ping" packets for setting its own IP address if this ++ * option is set. If so, uIP will start with an empty IP address and ++ * the destination IP address of the first incoming "ping" (ICMP echo) ++ * packet will be used for setting the hosts IP address. ++ * ++ * \note This works only if UIP_FIXEDADDR is 0. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_PINGADDRCONF 0 ++ ++#define UIP_IPADDR0 192 /**< The first octet of the IP address of ++ this uIP node, if UIP_FIXEDADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_IPADDR1 168 /**< The second octet of the IP address of ++ this uIP node, if UIP_FIXEDADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_IPADDR2 0 /**< The third octet of the IP address of ++ this uIP node, if UIP_FIXEDADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_IPADDR3 250 /**< The fourth octet of the IP address of ++ this uIP node, if UIP_FIXEDADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++ ++#define UIP_NETMASK0 255 /**< The first octet of the netmask of ++ this uIP node, if UIP_FIXEDADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_NETMASK1 255 /**< The second octet of the netmask of ++ this uIP node, if UIP_FIXEDADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_NETMASK2 255 /**< The third octet of the netmask of ++ this uIP node, if UIP_FIXEDADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_NETMASK3 0 /**< The fourth octet of the netmask of ++ this uIP node, if UIP_FIXEDADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++ ++#define UIP_DRIPADDR0 192 /**< The first octet of the IP address of ++ the default router, if UIP_FIXEDADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_DRIPADDR1 168 /**< The second octet of the IP address of ++ the default router, if UIP_FIXEDADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_DRIPADDR2 0 /**< The third octet of the IP address of ++ the default router, if UIP_FIXEDADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_DRIPADDR3 1 /**< The fourth octet of the IP address of ++ the default router, if UIP_FIXEDADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++ ++/** ++ * Specifies if the uIP ARP module should be compiled with a fixed ++ * Ethernet MAC address or not. ++ * ++ * If this configuration option is 0, the macro uip_setethaddr() can ++ * be used to specify the Ethernet address at run-time. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_FIXEDETHADDR 0 ++ ++#define UIP_ETHADDR0 0x00 /**< The first octet of the Ethernet ++ address if UIP_FIXEDETHADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_ETHADDR1 0xbd /**< The second octet of the Ethernet ++ address if UIP_FIXEDETHADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_ETHADDR2 0x3b /**< The third octet of the Ethernet ++ address if UIP_FIXEDETHADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_ETHADDR3 0x33 /**< The fourth octet of the Ethernet ++ address if UIP_FIXEDETHADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_ETHADDR4 0x05 /**< The fifth octet of the Ethernet ++ address if UIP_FIXEDETHADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++#define UIP_ETHADDR5 0x71 /**< The sixth octet of the Ethernet ++ address if UIP_FIXEDETHADDR is ++ 1. \hideinitializer */ ++ ++/** @} */ ++/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipoptip IP configuration options ++ * @{ ++ * ++ */ ++/** ++ * The IP TTL (time to live) of IP packets sent by uIP. ++ * ++ * This should normally not be changed. ++ */ ++#define UIP_TTL 255 ++ ++/** ++ * Turn on support for IP packet reassembly. ++ * ++ * uIP supports reassembly of fragmented IP packets. This features ++ * requires an additonal amount of RAM to hold the reassembly buffer ++ * and the reassembly code size is approximately 700 bytes. The ++ * reassembly buffer is of the same size as the uip_buf buffer ++ * (configured by UIP_BUFSIZE). ++ * ++ * \note IP packet reassembly is not heavily tested. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_REASSEMBLY 0 ++ ++/** ++ * The maximum time an IP fragment should wait in the reassembly ++ * buffer before it is dropped. ++ * ++ */ ++#define UIP_REASS_MAXAGE 40 ++ ++/** @} */ ++ ++/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipoptudp UDP configuration options ++ * @{ ++ * ++ * \note The UDP support in uIP is still not entirely complete; there ++ * is no support for sending or receiving broadcast or multicast ++ * packets, but it works well enough to support a number of vital ++ * applications such as DNS queries, though ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * Toggles wether UDP support should be compiled in or not. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_UDP 0 ++ ++/** ++ * Toggles if UDP checksums should be used or not. ++ * ++ * \note Support for UDP checksums is currently not included in uIP, ++ * so this option has no function. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS 0 ++ ++/** ++ * The maximum amount of concurrent UDP connections. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_UDP_CONNS 10 ++ ++/** ++ * The name of the function that should be called when UDP datagrams arrive. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_UDP_APPCALL udp_appcall ++ ++/** @} */ ++/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipopttcp TCP configuration options ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * Determines if support for opening connections from uIP should be ++ * compiled in. ++ * ++ * If the applications that are running on top of uIP for this project ++ * do not need to open outgoing TCP connections, this configration ++ * option can be turned off to reduce the code size of uIP. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN 1 ++ ++/** ++ * The maximum number of simultaneously open TCP connections. ++ * ++ * Since the TCP connections are statically allocated, turning this ++ * configuration knob down results in less RAM used. Each TCP ++ * connection requires approximatly 30 bytes of memory. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_CONNS 10 ++ ++/** ++ * The maximum number of simultaneously listening TCP ports. ++ * ++ * Each listening TCP port requires 2 bytes of memory. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_LISTENPORTS 10 ++ ++/** ++ * The size of the advertised receiver's window. ++ * ++ * Should be set low (i.e., to the size of the uip_buf buffer) is the ++ * application is slow to process incoming data, or high (32768 bytes) ++ * if the application processes data quickly. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_RECEIVE_WINDOW 32768 ++ ++/** ++ * Determines if support for TCP urgent data notification should be ++ * compiled in. ++ * ++ * Urgent data (out-of-band data) is a rarely used TCP feature that ++ * very seldom would be required. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_URGDATA 1 ++ ++/** ++ * The initial retransmission timeout counted in timer pulses. ++ * ++ * This should not be changed. ++ */ ++#define UIP_RTO 3 ++ ++/** ++ * The maximum number of times a segment should be retransmitted ++ * before the connection should be aborted. ++ * ++ * This should not be changed. ++ */ ++#define UIP_MAXRTX 8 ++ ++/** ++ * The maximum number of times a SYN segment should be retransmitted ++ * before a connection request should be deemed to have been ++ * unsuccessful. ++ * ++ * This should not need to be changed. ++ */ ++#define UIP_MAXSYNRTX 3 ++ ++/** ++ * The TCP maximum segment size. ++ * ++ * This is should not be to set to more than UIP_BUFSIZE - UIP_LLH_LEN - 40. ++ */ ++#define UIP_TCP_MSS (UIP_BUFSIZE - UIP_LLH_LEN - 40) ++ ++/** ++ * How long a connection should stay in the TIME_WAIT state. ++ * ++ * This configiration option has no real implication, and it should be ++ * left untouched. ++ */ ++#define UIP_TIME_WAIT_TIMEOUT 120 ++ ++ ++/** @} */ ++/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipoptarp ARP configuration options ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * The size of the ARP table. ++ * ++ * This option should be set to a larger value if this uIP node will ++ * have many connections from the local network. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE 8 ++ ++/** ++ * The maxium age of ARP table entries measured in 10ths of seconds. ++ * ++ * An UIP_ARP_MAXAGE of 120 corresponds to 20 minutes (BSD ++ * default). ++ */ ++#define UIP_ARP_MAXAGE 120 ++ ++/** @} */ ++ ++/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipoptgeneral General configuration options ++ * @{ ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * The size of the uIP packet buffer. ++ * ++ * The uIP packet buffer should not be smaller than 60 bytes, and does ++ * not need to be larger than 1500 bytes. Lower size results in lower ++ * TCP throughput, larger size results in higher TCP throughput. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_BUFSIZE 1500 ++ ++ ++/** ++ * Determines if statistics support should be compiled in. ++ * ++ * The statistics is useful for debugging and to show the user. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_STATISTICS 1 ++ ++/** ++ * Determines if logging of certain events should be compiled in. ++ * ++ * This is useful mostly for debugging. The function uip_log() ++ * must be implemented to suit the architecture of the project, if ++ * logging is turned on. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_LOGGING 0 ++ ++/** ++ * Print out a uIP log message. ++ * ++ * This function must be implemented by the module that uses uIP, and ++ * is called by uIP whenever a log message is generated. ++ */ ++void uip_log(char *msg); ++ ++/** ++ * The link level header length. ++ * ++ * This is the offset into the uip_buf where the IP header can be ++ * found. For Ethernet, this should be set to 14. For SLIP, this ++ * should be set to 0. ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++#define UIP_LLH_LEN 14 ++ ++ ++/** @} */ ++/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipoptcpu CPU architecture configuration ++ * @{ ++ * ++ * The CPU architecture configuration is where the endianess of the ++ * CPU on which uIP is to be run is specified. Most CPUs today are ++ * little endian, and the most notable exception are the Motorolas ++ * which are big endian. The BYTE_ORDER macro should be changed to ++ * reflect the CPU architecture on which uIP is to be run. ++ */ ++#ifndef LITTLE_ENDIAN ++#define LITTLE_ENDIAN 3412 ++#endif /* LITTLE_ENDIAN */ ++#ifndef BIG_ENDIAN ++#define BIG_ENDIAN 1234 ++#endif /* BIGE_ENDIAN */ ++ ++/** ++ * The byte order of the CPU architecture on which uIP is to be run. ++ * ++ * This option can be either BIG_ENDIAN (Motorola byte order) or ++ * LITTLE_ENDIAN (Intel byte order). ++ * ++ * \hideinitializer ++ */ ++/*#ifndef BYTE_ORDER*/ ++#define BYTE_ORDER BIG_ENDIAN ++/*#endif*/ /* BYTE_ORDER */ ++ ++/** @} */ ++/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ ++ ++/** ++ * \defgroup uipoptapp Appication specific configurations ++ * @{ ++ * ++ * An uIP application is implemented using a single application ++ * function that is called by uIP whenever a TCP/IP event occurs. The ++ * name of this function must be registered with uIP at compile time ++ * using the UIP_APPCALL definition. ++ * ++ * uIP applications can store the application state within the ++ * uip_conn structure by specifying the size of the application ++ * structure with the UIP_APPSTATE_SIZE macro. ++ * ++ * The file containing the definitions must be included in the ++ * uipopt.h file. ++ * ++ * The following example illustrates how this can look. ++ \code ++ ++void httpd_appcall(void); ++#define UIP_APPCALL httpd_appcall ++ ++struct httpd_state { ++ u8_t state; ++ u16_t count; ++ char *dataptr; ++ char *script; ++}; ++#define UIP_APPSTATE_SIZE (sizeof(struct httpd_state)) ++ \endcode ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \var #define UIP_APPCALL ++ * ++ * The name of the application function that uIP should call in ++ * response to TCP/IP events. ++ * ++ */ ++ ++/** ++ * \var #define UIP_APPSTATE_SIZE ++ * ++ * The size of the application state that is to be stored in the ++ * uip_conn structure. ++ */ ++/** @} */ ++ ++/* Include the header file for the application program that should be ++ used. If you don't use the example web server, you should change ++ this. */ ++#include "httpd.h" ++ ++ ++#endif /* __UIPOPT_H__ */ |